1 \# --------------------------------------------------------------------------
3 \# Copyright 1996-2016 The NASM Authors - All Rights Reserved
4 \# See the file AUTHORS included with the NASM distribution for
5 \# the specific copyright holders.
7 \# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
8 \# modification, are permitted provided that the following
11 \# * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
12 \# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
13 \# * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above
14 \# copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
15 \# disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided
16 \# with the distribution.
18 \# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
19 \# CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
20 \# INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
21 \# MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
22 \# DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR
23 \# CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
24 \# SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
25 \# NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
26 \# LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
27 \# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
28 \# CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
29 \# OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE,
30 \# EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
32 \# --------------------------------------------------------------------------
34 \# Source code to NASM documentation
36 \M{category}{Programming}
37 \M{title}{NASM - The Netwide Assembler}
39 \M{author}{The NASM Development Team}
40 \M{copyright_tail}{-- All Rights Reserved}
41 \M{license}{This document is redistributable under the license given in the file "LICENSE" distributed in the NASM archive.}
42 \M{summary}{This file documents NASM, the Netwide Assembler: an assembler targetting the Intel x86 series of processors, with portable source.}
45 \M{infotitle}{The Netwide Assembler for x86}
46 \M{epslogo}{nasmlogo.eps}
53 \IR{-MD} \c{-MD} option
54 \IR{-MF} \c{-MF} option
55 \IR{-MG} \c{-MG} option
56 \IR{-MP} \c{-MP} option
57 \IR{-MQ} \c{-MQ} option
58 \IR{-MT} \c{-MT} option
79 \IR{!=} \c{!=} operator
80 \IR{$, here} \c{$}, Here token
81 \IR{$, prefix} \c{$}, prefix
84 \IR{%%} \c{%%} operator
85 \IR{%+1} \c{%+1} and \c{%-1} syntax
87 \IR{%0} \c{%0} parameter count
89 \IR{&&} \c{&&} operator
91 \IR{..@} \c{..@} symbol prefix
93 \IR{//} \c{//} operator
95 \IR{<<} \c{<<} operator
96 \IR{<=} \c{<=} operator
97 \IR{<>} \c{<>} operator
99 \IR{==} \c{==} operator
100 \IR{>} \c{>} operator
101 \IR{>=} \c{>=} operator
102 \IR{>>} \c{>>} operator
103 \IR{?} \c{?} MASM syntax
104 \IR{^} \c{^} operator
105 \IR{^^} \c{^^} operator
106 \IR{|} \c{|} operator
107 \IR{||} \c{||} operator
108 \IR{~} \c{~} operator
109 \IR{%$} \c{%$} and \c{%$$} prefixes
111 \IR{+ opaddition} \c{+} operator, binary
112 \IR{+ opunary} \c{+} operator, unary
113 \IR{+ modifier} \c{+} modifier
114 \IR{- opsubtraction} \c{-} operator, binary
115 \IR{- opunary} \c{-} operator, unary
116 \IR{! opunary} \c{!} operator, unary
117 \IR{alignment, in bin sections} alignment, in \c{bin} sections
118 \IR{alignment, in elf sections} alignment, in \c{elf} sections
119 \IR{alignment, in win32 sections} alignment, in \c{win32} sections
120 \IR{alignment, of elf common variables} alignment, of \c{elf} common
122 \IR{alignment, in obj sections} alignment, in \c{obj} sections
123 \IR{a.out, bsd version} \c{a.out}, BSD version
124 \IR{a.out, linux version} \c{a.out}, Linux version
125 \IR{autoconf} Autoconf
127 \IR{bitwise and} bitwise AND
128 \IR{bitwise or} bitwise OR
129 \IR{bitwise xor} bitwise XOR
130 \IR{block ifs} block IFs
131 \IR{borland pascal} Borland, Pascal
132 \IR{borland's win32 compilers} Borland, Win32 compilers
133 \IR{braces, after % sign} braces, after \c{%} sign
135 \IR{c calling convention} C calling convention
136 \IR{c symbol names} C symbol names
137 \IA{critical expressions}{critical expression}
138 \IA{command line}{command-line}
139 \IA{case sensitivity}{case sensitive}
140 \IA{case-sensitive}{case sensitive}
141 \IA{case-insensitive}{case sensitive}
142 \IA{character constants}{character constant}
143 \IR{codeview} CodeView debugging format
144 \IR{common object file format} Common Object File Format
145 \IR{common variables, alignment in elf} common variables, alignment
147 \IR{common, elf extensions to} \c{COMMON}, \c{elf} extensions to
148 \IR{common, obj extensions to} \c{COMMON}, \c{obj} extensions to
149 \IR{declaring structure} declaring structures
150 \IR{default-wrt mechanism} default-\c{WRT} mechanism
153 \IR{dll symbols, exporting} DLL symbols, exporting
154 \IR{dll symbols, importing} DLL symbols, importing
156 \IR{dos archive} DOS archive
157 \IR{dos source archive} DOS source archive
158 \IA{effective address}{effective addresses}
159 \IA{effective-address}{effective addresses}
161 \IR{elf, 16-bit code and} ELF, 16-bit code and
162 \IR{elf shared libraries} ELF, shared libraries
165 \IR{elfx32} \c{elfx32}
166 \IR{executable and linkable format} Executable and Linkable Format
167 \IR{extern, obj extensions to} \c{EXTERN}, \c{obj} extensions to
168 \IR{extern, rdf extensions to} \c{EXTERN}, \c{rdf} extensions to
169 \IR{floating-point, constants} floating-point, constants
170 \IR{floating-point, packed bcd constants} floating-point, packed BCD constants
172 \IR{freelink} FreeLink
173 \IR{functions, c calling convention} functions, C calling convention
174 \IR{functions, pascal calling convention} functions, Pascal calling
176 \IR{global, aoutb extensions to} \c{GLOBAL}, \c{aoutb} extensions to
177 \IR{global, elf extensions to} \c{GLOBAL}, \c{elf} extensions to
178 \IR{global, rdf extensions to} \c{GLOBAL}, \c{rdf} extensions to
180 \IR{got relocations} \c{GOT} relocations
181 \IR{gotoff relocation} \c{GOTOFF} relocations
182 \IR{gotpc relocation} \c{GOTPC} relocations
183 \IR{intel number formats} Intel number formats
184 \IR{linux, elf} Linux, ELF
185 \IR{linux, a.out} Linux, \c{a.out}
186 \IR{linux, as86} Linux, \c{as86}
187 \IR{logical and} logical AND
188 \IR{logical or} logical OR
189 \IR{logical xor} logical XOR
190 \IR{mach object file format} Mach, object file format
192 \IR{mach-o} Mach-O, object file format
193 \IR{macho32} \c{macho32}
194 \IR{macho64} \c{macho64}
197 \IA{memory reference}{memory references}
199 \IA{misc directory}{misc subdirectory}
200 \IR{misc subdirectory} \c{misc} subdirectory
201 \IR{microsoft omf} Microsoft OMF
202 \IR{mmx registers} MMX registers
203 \IA{modr/m}{modr/m byte}
204 \IR{modr/m byte} ModR/M byte
206 \IR{ms-dos device drivers} MS-DOS device drivers
207 \IR{multipush} \c{multipush} macro
209 \IR{nasm version} NASM version
213 \IR{operating system} operating system
215 \IR{pascal calling convention}Pascal calling convention
216 \IR{passes} passes, assembly
221 \IR{plt} \c{PLT} relocations
222 \IA{pre-defining macros}{pre-define}
223 \IA{preprocessor expressions}{preprocessor, expressions}
224 \IA{preprocessor loops}{preprocessor, loops}
225 \IA{preprocessor variables}{preprocessor, variables}
226 \IA{rdoff subdirectory}{rdoff}
227 \IR{rdoff} \c{rdoff} subdirectory
228 \IR{relocatable dynamic object file format} Relocatable Dynamic
230 \IR{relocations, pic-specific} relocations, PIC-specific
231 \IA{repeating}{repeating code}
232 \IR{section alignment, in elf} section alignment, in \c{elf}
233 \IR{section alignment, in bin} section alignment, in \c{bin}
234 \IR{section alignment, in obj} section alignment, in \c{obj}
235 \IR{section alignment, in win32} section alignment, in \c{win32}
236 \IR{section, elf extensions to} \c{SECTION}, \c{elf} extensions to
237 \IR{section, macho extensions to} \c{SECTION}, \c{macho} extensions to
238 \IR{section, win32 extensions to} \c{SECTION}, \c{win32} extensions to
239 \IR{segment alignment, in bin} segment alignment, in \c{bin}
240 \IR{segment alignment, in obj} segment alignment, in \c{obj}
241 \IR{segment, obj extensions to} \c{SEGMENT}, \c{elf} extensions to
242 \IR{segment names, borland pascal} segment names, Borland Pascal
243 \IR{shift command} \c{shift} command
245 \IR{sib byte} SIB byte
246 \IR{align, smart} \c{ALIGN}, smart
247 \IA{sectalign}{sectalign}
248 \IR{solaris x86} Solaris x86
249 \IA{standard section names}{standardized section names}
250 \IR{symbols, exporting from dlls} symbols, exporting from DLLs
251 \IR{symbols, importing from dlls} symbols, importing from DLLs
252 \IR{test subdirectory} \c{test} subdirectory
254 \IR{underscore, in c symbols} underscore, in C symbols
260 \IA{sco unix}{unix, sco}
261 \IR{unix, sco} Unix, SCO
262 \IA{unix source archive}{unix, source archive}
263 \IR{unix, source archive} Unix, source archive
264 \IA{unix system v}{unix, system v}
265 \IR{unix, system v} Unix, System V
266 \IR{unixware} UnixWare
268 \IR{version number of nasm} version number of NASM
269 \IR{visual c++} Visual C++
270 \IR{www page} WWW page
274 \IR{windows 95} Windows 95
275 \IR{windows nt} Windows NT
276 \# \IC{program entry point}{entry point, program}
277 \# \IC{program entry point}{start point, program}
278 \# \IC{MS-DOS device drivers}{device drivers, MS-DOS}
279 \# \IC{16-bit mode, versus 32-bit mode}{32-bit mode, versus 16-bit mode}
280 \# \IC{c symbol names}{symbol names, in C}
283 \C{intro} Introduction
285 \H{whatsnasm} What Is NASM?
287 The Netwide Assembler, NASM, is an 80x86 and x86-64 assembler designed
288 for portability and modularity. It supports a range of object file
289 formats, including Linux and \c{*BSD} \c{a.out}, \c{ELF}, \c{COFF},
290 \c{Mach-O}, Microsoft 16-bit \c{OBJ}, \c{Win32} and \c{Win64}. It will
291 also output plain binary files. Its syntax is designed to be simple
292 and easy to understand, similar to Intel's but less complex. It
293 supports all currently known x86 architectural extensions, and has
294 strong support for macros.
297 \S{yaasm} Why Yet Another Assembler?
299 The Netwide Assembler grew out of an idea on \i\c{comp.lang.asm.x86}
300 (or possibly \i\c{alt.lang.asm} - I forget which), which was
301 essentially that there didn't seem to be a good \e{free} x86-series
302 assembler around, and that maybe someone ought to write one.
304 \b \i\c{a86} is good, but not free, and in particular you don't get any
305 32-bit capability until you pay. It's DOS only, too.
307 \b \i\c{gas} is free, and ports over to DOS and Unix, but it's not
308 very good, since it's designed to be a back end to \i\c{gcc}, which
309 always feeds it correct code. So its error checking is minimal. Also,
310 its syntax is horrible, from the point of view of anyone trying to
311 actually \e{write} anything in it. Plus you can't write 16-bit code in
314 \b \i\c{as86} is specific to Minix and Linux, and (my version at least)
315 doesn't seem to have much (or any) documentation.
317 \b \i\c{MASM} isn't very good, and it's (was) expensive, and it runs only under
320 \b \i\c{TASM} is better, but still strives for MASM compatibility,
321 which means millions of directives and tons of red tape. And its syntax
322 is essentially MASM's, with the contradictions and quirks that
323 entails (although it sorts out some of those by means of Ideal mode.)
324 It's expensive too. And it's DOS-only.
326 So here, for your coding pleasure, is NASM. At present it's
327 still in prototype stage - we don't promise that it can outperform
328 any of these assemblers. But please, \e{please} send us bug reports,
329 fixes, helpful information, and anything else you can get your hands
330 on (and thanks to the many people who've done this already! You all
331 know who you are), and we'll improve it out of all recognition.
335 \S{legal} \i{License} Conditions
337 Please see the file \c{LICENSE}, supplied as part of any NASM
338 distribution archive, for the license conditions under which you may
339 use NASM. NASM is now under the so-called 2-clause BSD license, also
340 known as the simplified BSD license.
342 Copyright 1996-2016 the NASM Authors - All rights reserved.
344 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
345 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are
348 \b Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
349 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
351 \b Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
352 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
353 documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
355 THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
356 CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
357 INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
358 MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
359 DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR
360 CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
361 SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
362 NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
363 LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
364 HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
365 CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
366 OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE,
367 EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
370 \H{contact} Contact Information
372 The current version of NASM (since about 0.98.08) is maintained by a
373 team of developers, accessible through the \c{nasm-devel} mailing list
374 (see below for the link).
375 If you want to report a bug, please read \k{bugs} first.
377 NASM has a \i{website} at
378 \W{http://www.nasm.us/}\c{http://www.nasm.us/}. If it's not there,
381 \i{New releases}, \i{release candidates}, and \I{snapshots, daily
382 development}\i{daily development snapshots} of NASM are available from
383 the official web site.
385 Announcements are posted to
386 \W{news:comp.lang.asm.x86}\i\c{comp.lang.asm.x86},
388 \W{http://www.freshmeat.net/}\c{http://www.freshmeat.net/}.
390 If you want information about the current development status, please
391 subscribe to the \i\c{nasm-devel} email list; see link from the
395 \H{install} Installation
397 \S{instdos} \i{Installing} NASM under MS-\i{DOS} or Windows
399 Once you've obtained the appropriate archive for NASM,
400 \i\c{nasm-XXX-dos.zip} or \i\c{nasm-XXX-win32.zip} (where \c{XXX}
401 denotes the version number of NASM contained in the archive), unpack
402 it into its own directory (for example \c{c:\\nasm}).
404 The archive will contain a set of executable files: the NASM
405 executable file \i\c{nasm.exe}, the NDISASM executable file
406 \i\c{ndisasm.exe}, and possibly additional utilities to handle the
409 The only file NASM needs to run is its own executable, so copy
410 \c{nasm.exe} to a directory on your PATH, or alternatively edit
411 \i\c{autoexec.bat} to add the \c{nasm} directory to your
412 \i\c{PATH} (to do that under Windows XP, go to Start > Control Panel >
413 System > Advanced > Environment Variables; these instructions may work
414 under other versions of Windows as well.)
416 That's it - NASM is installed. You don't need the nasm directory
417 to be present to run NASM (unless you've added it to your \c{PATH}),
418 so you can delete it if you need to save space; however, you may
419 want to keep the documentation or test programs.
421 If you've downloaded the \i{DOS source archive}, \i\c{nasm-XXX.zip},
422 the \c{nasm} directory will also contain the full NASM \i{source
423 code}, and a selection of \i{Makefiles} you can (hopefully) use to
424 rebuild your copy of NASM from scratch. See the file \c{INSTALL} in
427 Note that a number of files are generated from other files by Perl
428 scripts. Although the NASM source distribution includes these
429 generated files, you will need to rebuild them (and hence, will need a
430 Perl interpreter) if you change insns.dat, standard.mac or the
431 documentation. It is possible future source distributions may not
432 include these files at all. Ports of \i{Perl} for a variety of
433 platforms, including DOS and Windows, are available from
434 \W{http://www.cpan.org/ports/}\i{www.cpan.org}.
437 \S{instdos} Installing NASM under \i{Unix}
439 Once you've obtained the \i{Unix source archive} for NASM,
440 \i\c{nasm-XXX.tar.gz} (where \c{XXX} denotes the version number of
441 NASM contained in the archive), unpack it into a directory such
442 as \c{/usr/local/src}. The archive, when unpacked, will create its
443 own subdirectory \c{nasm-XXX}.
445 NASM is an \I{Autoconf}\I\c{configure}auto-configuring package: once
446 you've unpacked it, \c{cd} to the directory it's been unpacked into
447 and type \c{./configure}. This shell script will find the best C
448 compiler to use for building NASM and set up \i{Makefiles}
451 Once NASM has auto-configured, you can type \i\c{make} to build the
452 \c{nasm} and \c{ndisasm} binaries, and then \c{make install} to
453 install them in \c{/usr/local/bin} and install the \i{man pages}
454 \i\c{nasm.1} and \i\c{ndisasm.1} in \c{/usr/local/man/man1}.
455 Alternatively, you can give options such as \c{--prefix} to the
456 configure script (see the file \i\c{INSTALL} for more details), or
457 install the programs yourself.
459 NASM also comes with a set of utilities for handling the \c{RDOFF}
460 custom object-file format, which are in the \i\c{rdoff} subdirectory
461 of the NASM archive. You can build these with \c{make rdf} and
462 install them with \c{make rdf_install}, if you want them.
465 \C{running} Running NASM
467 \H{syntax} NASM \i{Command-Line} Syntax
469 To assemble a file, you issue a command of the form
471 \c nasm -f <format> <filename> [-o <output>]
475 \c nasm -f elf myfile.asm
477 will assemble \c{myfile.asm} into an \c{ELF} object file \c{myfile.o}. And
479 \c nasm -f bin myfile.asm -o myfile.com
481 will assemble \c{myfile.asm} into a raw binary file \c{myfile.com}.
483 To produce a listing file, with the hex codes output from NASM
484 displayed on the left of the original sources, use the \c{-l} option
485 to give a listing file name, for example:
487 \c nasm -f coff myfile.asm -l myfile.lst
489 To get further usage instructions from NASM, try typing
493 As \c{-hf}, this will also list the available output file formats, and what they
496 If you use Linux but aren't sure whether your system is \c{a.out}
501 (in the directory in which you put the NASM binary when you
502 installed it). If it says something like
504 \c nasm: ELF 32-bit LSB executable i386 (386 and up) Version 1
506 then your system is \c{ELF}, and you should use the option \c{-f elf}
507 when you want NASM to produce Linux object files. If it says
509 \c nasm: Linux/i386 demand-paged executable (QMAGIC)
511 or something similar, your system is \c{a.out}, and you should use
512 \c{-f aout} instead (Linux \c{a.out} systems have long been obsolete,
513 and are rare these days.)
515 Like Unix compilers and assemblers, NASM is silent unless it
516 goes wrong: you won't see any output at all, unless it gives error
520 \S{opt-o} The \i\c{-o} Option: Specifying the Output File Name
522 NASM will normally choose the name of your output file for you;
523 precisely how it does this is dependent on the object file format.
524 For Microsoft object file formats (\c{obj}, \c{win32} and \c{win64}),
525 it will remove the \c{.asm} \i{extension} (or whatever extension you
526 like to use - NASM doesn't care) from your source file name and
527 substitute \c{.obj}. For Unix object file formats (\c{aout}, \c{as86},
528 \c{coff}, \c{elf32}, \c{elf64}, \c{elfx32}, \c{ieee}, \c{macho32} and
529 \c{macho64}) it will substitute \c{.o}. For \c{dbg}, \c{rdf}, \c{ith}
530 and \c{srec}, it will use \c{.dbg}, \c{.rdf}, \c{.ith} and \c{.srec},
531 respectively, and for the \c{bin} format it will simply remove the
532 extension, so that \c{myfile.asm} produces the output file \c{myfile}.
534 If the output file already exists, NASM will overwrite it, unless it
535 has the same name as the input file, in which case it will give a
536 warning and use \i\c{nasm.out} as the output file name instead.
538 For situations in which this behaviour is unacceptable, NASM
539 provides the \c{-o} command-line option, which allows you to specify
540 your desired output file name. You invoke \c{-o} by following it
541 with the name you wish for the output file, either with or without
542 an intervening space. For example:
544 \c nasm -f bin program.asm -o program.com
545 \c nasm -f bin driver.asm -odriver.sys
547 Note that this is a small o, and is different from a capital O , which
548 is used to specify the number of optimisation passes required. See \k{opt-O}.
551 \S{opt-f} The \i\c{-f} Option: Specifying the \i{Output File Format}
553 If you do not supply the \c{-f} option to NASM, it will choose an
554 output file format for you itself. In the distribution versions of
555 NASM, the default is always \i\c{bin}; if you've compiled your own
556 copy of NASM, you can redefine \i\c{OF_DEFAULT} at compile time and
557 choose what you want the default to be.
559 Like \c{-o}, the intervening space between \c{-f} and the output
560 file format is optional; so \c{-f elf} and \c{-felf} are both valid.
562 A complete list of the available output file formats can be given by
563 issuing the command \i\c{nasm -hf}.
566 \S{opt-l} The \i\c{-l} Option: Generating a \i{Listing File}
568 If you supply the \c{-l} option to NASM, followed (with the usual
569 optional space) by a file name, NASM will generate a
570 \i{source-listing file} for you, in which addresses and generated
571 code are listed on the left, and the actual source code, with
572 expansions of multi-line macros (except those which specifically
573 request no expansion in source listings: see \k{nolist}) on the
576 \c nasm -f elf myfile.asm -l myfile.lst
578 If a list file is selected, you may turn off listing for a
579 section of your source with \c{[list -]}, and turn it back on
580 with \c{[list +]}, (the default, obviously). There is no "user
581 form" (without the brackets). This can be used to list only
582 sections of interest, avoiding excessively long listings.
585 \S{opt-M} The \i\c{-M} Option: Generate \i{Makefile Dependencies}
587 This option can be used to generate makefile dependencies on stdout.
588 This can be redirected to a file for further processing. For example:
590 \c nasm -M myfile.asm > myfile.dep
593 \S{opt-MG} The \i\c{-MG} Option: Generate \i{Makefile Dependencies}
595 This option can be used to generate makefile dependencies on stdout.
596 This differs from the \c{-M} option in that if a nonexisting file is
597 encountered, it is assumed to be a generated file and is added to the
598 dependency list without a prefix.
601 \S{opt-MF} The \i\c\{-MF} Option: Set Makefile Dependency File
603 This option can be used with the \c{-M} or \c{-MG} options to send the
604 output to a file, rather than to stdout. For example:
606 \c nasm -M -MF myfile.dep myfile.asm
609 \S{opt-MD} The \i\c{-MD} Option: Assemble and Generate Dependencies
611 The \c{-MD} option acts as the combination of the \c{-M} and \c{-MF}
612 options (i.e. a filename has to be specified.) However, unlike the
613 \c{-M} or \c{-MG} options, \c{-MD} does \e{not} inhibit the normal
614 operation of the assembler. Use this to automatically generate
615 updated dependencies with every assembly session. For example:
617 \c nasm -f elf -o myfile.o -MD myfile.dep myfile.asm
620 \S{opt-MT} The \i\c{-MT} Option: Dependency Target Name
622 The \c{-MT} option can be used to override the default name of the
623 dependency target. This is normally the same as the output filename,
624 specified by the \c{-o} option.
627 \S{opt-MQ} The \i\c{-MQ} Option: Dependency Target Name (Quoted)
629 The \c{-MQ} option acts as the \c{-MT} option, except it tries to
630 quote characters that have special meaning in Makefile syntax. This
631 is not foolproof, as not all characters with special meaning are
632 quotable in Make. The default output (if no \c{-MT} or \c{-MQ} option
633 is specified) is automatically quoted.
636 \S{opt-MP} The \i\c{-MP} Option: Emit phony targets
638 When used with any of the dependency generation options, the \c{-MP}
639 option causes NASM to emit a phony target without dependencies for
640 each header file. This prevents Make from complaining if a header
641 file has been removed.
644 \S{opt-F} The \i\c{-F} Option: Selecting a \i{Debug Information Format}
646 This option is used to select the format of the debug information
647 emitted into the output file, to be used by a debugger (or \e{will}
648 be). Prior to version 2.03.01, the use of this switch did \e{not} enable
649 output of the selected debug info format. Use \c{-g}, see \k{opt-g},
650 to enable output. Versions 2.03.01 and later automatically enable \c{-g}
651 if \c{-F} is specified.
653 A complete list of the available debug file formats for an output
654 format can be seen by issuing the command \c{nasm -f <format> -y}. Not
655 all output formats currently support debugging output. See \k{opt-y}.
657 This should not be confused with the \c{-f dbg} output format option which
658 is not built into NASM by default. For information on how
659 to enable it when building from the sources, see \k{dbgfmt}.
662 \S{opt-g} The \i\c{-g} Option: Enabling \i{Debug Information}.
664 This option can be used to generate debugging information in the specified
665 format. See \k{opt-F}. Using \c{-g} without \c{-F} results in emitting
666 debug info in the default format, if any, for the selected output format.
667 If no debug information is currently implemented in the selected output
668 format, \c{-g} is \e{silently ignored}.
671 \S{opt-X} The \i\c{-X} Option: Selecting an \i{Error Reporting Format}
673 This option can be used to select an error reporting format for any
674 error messages that might be produced by NASM.
676 Currently, two error reporting formats may be selected. They are
677 the \c{-Xvc} option and the \c{-Xgnu} option. The GNU format is
678 the default and looks like this:
680 \c filename.asm:65: error: specific error message
682 where \c{filename.asm} is the name of the source file in which the
683 error was detected, \c{65} is the source file line number on which
684 the error was detected, \c{error} is the severity of the error (this
685 could be \c{warning}), and \c{specific error message} is a more
686 detailed text message which should help pinpoint the exact problem.
688 The other format, specified by \c{-Xvc} is the style used by Microsoft
689 Visual C++ and some other programs. It looks like this:
691 \c filename.asm(65) : error: specific error message
693 where the only difference is that the line number is in parentheses
694 instead of being delimited by colons.
696 See also the \c{Visual C++} output format, \k{win32fmt}.
698 \S{opt-Z} The \i\c{-Z} Option: Send Errors to a File
700 Under \I{DOS}\c{MS-DOS} it can be difficult (though there are ways) to
701 redirect the standard-error output of a program to a file. Since
702 NASM usually produces its warning and \i{error messages} on
703 \i\c{stderr}, this can make it hard to capture the errors if (for
704 example) you want to load them into an editor.
706 NASM therefore provides the \c{-Z} option, taking a filename argument
707 which causes errors to be sent to the specified files rather than
708 standard error. Therefore you can \I{redirecting errors}redirect
709 the errors into a file by typing
711 \c nasm -Z myfile.err -f obj myfile.asm
713 In earlier versions of NASM, this option was called \c{-E}, but it was
714 changed since \c{-E} is an option conventionally used for
715 preprocessing only, with disastrous results. See \k{opt-E}.
717 \S{opt-s} The \i\c{-s} Option: Send Errors to \i\c{stdout}
719 The \c{-s} option redirects \i{error messages} to \c{stdout} rather
720 than \c{stderr}, so it can be redirected under \I{DOS}\c{MS-DOS}. To
721 assemble the file \c{myfile.asm} and pipe its output to the \c{more}
722 program, you can type:
724 \c nasm -s -f obj myfile.asm | more
726 See also the \c{-Z} option, \k{opt-Z}.
729 \S{opt-i} The \i\c{-i}\I\c{-I} Option: Include File Search Directories
731 When NASM sees the \i\c{%include} or \i\c{%pathsearch} directive in a
732 source file (see \k{include}, \k{pathsearch} or \k{incbin}), it will
733 search for the given file not only in the current directory, but also
734 in any directories specified on the command line by the use of the
735 \c{-i} option. Therefore you can include files from a \i{macro
736 library}, for example, by typing
738 \c nasm -ic:\macrolib\ -f obj myfile.asm
740 (As usual, a space between \c{-i} and the path name is allowed, and
743 NASM, in the interests of complete source-code portability, does not
744 understand the file naming conventions of the OS it is running on;
745 the string you provide as an argument to the \c{-i} option will be
746 prepended exactly as written to the name of the include file.
747 Therefore the trailing backslash in the above example is necessary.
748 Under Unix, a trailing forward slash is similarly necessary.
750 (You can use this to your advantage, if you're really \i{perverse},
751 by noting that the option \c{-ifoo} will cause \c{%include "bar.i"}
752 to search for the file \c{foobar.i}...)
754 If you want to define a \e{standard} \i{include search path},
755 similar to \c{/usr/include} on Unix systems, you should place one or
756 more \c{-i} directives in the \c{NASMENV} environment variable (see
759 For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can also
760 be specified as \c{-I}.
763 \S{opt-p} The \i\c{-p}\I\c{-P} Option: \I{pre-including files}Pre-Include a File
765 \I\c{%include}NASM allows you to specify files to be
766 \e{pre-included} into your source file, by the use of the \c{-p}
769 \c nasm myfile.asm -p myinc.inc
771 is equivalent to running \c{nasm myfile.asm} and placing the
772 directive \c{%include "myinc.inc"} at the start of the file.
774 For consistency with the \c{-I}, \c{-D} and \c{-U} options, this
775 option can also be specified as \c{-P}.
778 \S{opt-d} The \i\c{-d}\I\c{-D} Option: \I{pre-defining macros}Pre-Define a Macro
780 \I\c{%define}Just as the \c{-p} option gives an alternative to placing
781 \c{%include} directives at the start of a source file, the \c{-d}
782 option gives an alternative to placing a \c{%define} directive. You
785 \c nasm myfile.asm -dFOO=100
787 as an alternative to placing the directive
791 at the start of the file. You can miss off the macro value, as well:
792 the option \c{-dFOO} is equivalent to coding \c{%define FOO}. This
793 form of the directive may be useful for selecting \i{assembly-time
794 options} which are then tested using \c{%ifdef}, for example
797 For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can also
798 be specified as \c{-D}.
801 \S{opt-u} The \i\c{-u}\I\c{-U} Option: \I{Undefining macros}Undefine a Macro
803 \I\c{%undef}The \c{-u} option undefines a macro that would otherwise
804 have been pre-defined, either automatically or by a \c{-p} or \c{-d}
805 option specified earlier on the command lines.
807 For example, the following command line:
809 \c nasm myfile.asm -dFOO=100 -uFOO
811 would result in \c{FOO} \e{not} being a predefined macro in the
812 program. This is useful to override options specified at a different
815 For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can also
816 be specified as \c{-U}.
819 \S{opt-E} The \i\c{-E}\I{-e} Option: Preprocess Only
821 NASM allows the \i{preprocessor} to be run on its own, up to a
822 point. Using the \c{-E} option (which requires no arguments) will
823 cause NASM to preprocess its input file, expand all the macro
824 references, remove all the comments and preprocessor directives, and
825 print the resulting file on standard output (or save it to a file,
826 if the \c{-o} option is also used).
828 This option cannot be applied to programs which require the
829 preprocessor to evaluate \I{preprocessor expressions}\i{expressions}
830 which depend on the values of symbols: so code such as
832 \c %assign tablesize ($-tablestart)
834 will cause an error in \i{preprocess-only mode}.
836 For compatiblity with older version of NASM, this option can also be
837 written \c{-e}. \c{-E} in older versions of NASM was the equivalent
838 of the current \c{-Z} option, \k{opt-Z}.
840 \S{opt-a} The \i\c{-a} Option: Don't Preprocess At All
842 If NASM is being used as the back end to a compiler, it might be
843 desirable to \I{suppressing preprocessing}suppress preprocessing
844 completely and assume the compiler has already done it, to save time
845 and increase compilation speeds. The \c{-a} option, requiring no
846 argument, instructs NASM to replace its powerful \i{preprocessor}
847 with a \i{stub preprocessor} which does nothing.
850 \S{opt-O} The \i\c{-O} Option: Specifying \i{Multipass Optimization}
852 Using the \c{-O} option, you can tell NASM to carry out different
853 levels of optimization. The syntax is:
855 \b \c{-O0}: No optimization. All operands take their long forms,
856 if a short form is not specified, except conditional jumps.
857 This is intended to match NASM 0.98 behavior.
859 \b \c{-O1}: Minimal optimization. As above, but immediate operands
860 which will fit in a signed byte are optimized,
861 unless the long form is specified. Conditional jumps default
862 to the long form unless otherwise specified.
864 \b \c{-Ox} (where \c{x} is the actual letter \c{x}): Multipass optimization.
865 Minimize branch offsets and signed immediate bytes,
866 overriding size specification unless the \c{strict} keyword
867 has been used (see \k{strict}). For compatibility with earlier
868 releases, the letter \c{x} may also be any number greater than
869 one. This number has no effect on the actual number of passes.
871 The \c{-Ox} mode is recommended for most uses, and is the default
874 Note that this is a capital \c{O}, and is different from a small \c{o}, which
875 is used to specify the output file name. See \k{opt-o}.
878 \S{opt-t} The \i\c{-t} Option: Enable TASM Compatibility Mode
880 NASM includes a limited form of compatibility with Borland's \i\c{TASM}.
881 When NASM's \c{-t} option is used, the following changes are made:
883 \b local labels may be prefixed with \c{@@} instead of \c{.}
885 \b size override is supported within brackets. In TASM compatible mode,
886 a size override inside square brackets changes the size of the operand,
887 and not the address type of the operand as it does in NASM syntax. E.g.
888 \c{mov eax,[DWORD val]} is valid syntax in TASM compatibility mode.
889 Note that you lose the ability to override the default address type for
892 \b unprefixed forms of some directives supported (\c{arg}, \c{elif},
893 \c{else}, \c{endif}, \c{if}, \c{ifdef}, \c{ifdifi}, \c{ifndef},
894 \c{include}, \c{local})
896 \S{opt-w} The \i\c{-w} and \i\c{-W} Options: Enable or Disable Assembly \i{Warnings}
898 NASM can observe many conditions during the course of assembly which
899 are worth mentioning to the user, but not a sufficiently severe
900 error to justify NASM refusing to generate an output file. These
901 conditions are reported like errors, but come up with the word
902 `warning' before the message. Warnings do not prevent NASM from
903 generating an output file and returning a success status to the
906 Some conditions are even less severe than that: they are only
907 sometimes worth mentioning to the user. Therefore NASM supports the
908 \c{-w} command-line option, which enables or disables certain
909 classes of assembly warning. Such warning classes are described by a
910 name, for example \c{orphan-labels}; you can enable warnings of
911 this class by the command-line option \c{-w+orphan-labels} and
912 disable it by \c{-w-orphan-labels}.
914 The \i{suppressible warning} classes are:
916 \b \i\c{macro-params} covers warnings about \i{multi-line macros}
917 being invoked with the wrong number of parameters. This warning
918 class is enabled by default; see \k{mlmacover} for an example of why
919 you might want to disable it.
921 \b \i\c{macro-selfref} warns if a macro references itself. This
922 warning class is disabled by default.
924 \b\i\c{macro-defaults} warns when a macro has more default
925 parameters than optional parameters. This warning class
926 is enabled by default; see \k{mlmacdef} for why you might want to disable it.
928 \b \i\c{orphan-labels} covers warnings about source lines which
929 contain no instruction but define a label without a trailing colon.
930 NASM warns about this somewhat obscure condition by default;
931 see \k{syntax} for more information.
933 \b \i\c{number-overflow} covers warnings about numeric constants which
934 don't fit in 64 bits. This warning class is enabled by default.
936 \b \i\c{gnu-elf-extensions} warns if 8-bit or 16-bit relocations
937 are used in \c{-f elf} format. The GNU extensions allow this.
938 This warning class is disabled by default.
940 \b \i\c{float-overflow} warns about floating point overflow.
943 \b \i\c{float-denorm} warns about floating point denormals.
946 \b \i\c{float-underflow} warns about floating point underflow.
949 \b \i\c{float-toolong} warns about too many digits in floating-point numbers.
952 \b \i\c{user} controls \c{%warning} directives (see \k{pperror}).
955 \b \i\c{lock} warns about \c{LOCK} prefixes on unlockable instructions.
958 \b \i\c{hle} warns about invalid use of the HLE \c{XACQUIRE} or \c{XRELEASE}
962 \b \i\c{bnd} warns about ineffective use of the \c{BND} prefix when a relaxed
963 form of jmp instruction becomes jmp short form.
966 \b \i\c{zext-reloc} warns that a relocation has been zero-extended due
967 to limitations in the output format.
969 \b \i\c\{ptr} warns about keywords used in other assemblers that might
970 indicate a mistake in the source code. Currently only the MASM
971 \c{PTR} keyword is recognized.
973 \b \i\c{error} causes warnings to be treated as errors. Disabled by
976 \b \i\c{all} is an alias for \e{all} suppressible warning classes (not
977 including \c{error}). Thus, \c{-w+all} enables all available warnings.
979 In addition, you can control warnings in the source code itself, using
980 the \i\c{[warning]} directive.
981 Warning classes may be enabled with \i\c{[warning +warning-name]},
982 disabled with \i\c{[warning -warning-name]} or reset to their
983 original value with \i\c{[warning *warning-name]}. No "user form"
984 (without the brackets) exists.
986 Since version 2.00, NASM has also supported the gcc-like syntax
987 \c{-Wwarning} and \c{-Wno-warning} instead of \c{-w+warning} and
988 \c{-w-warning}, respectively.
991 \S{opt-v} The \i\c{-v} Option: Display \i{Version} Info
993 Typing \c{NASM -v} will display the version of NASM which you are using,
994 and the date on which it was compiled.
996 You will need the version number if you report a bug.
998 For command-line compatibility with Yasm, the form \i\c{--v} is also
999 accepted for this option starting in NASM version 2.11.05.
1001 \S{opt-y} The \i\c{-y} Option: Display Available Debug Info Formats
1003 Typing \c{nasm -f <option> -y} will display a list of the available
1004 debug info formats for the given output format. The default format
1005 is indicated by an asterisk. For example:
1009 \c valid debug formats for 'elf32' output format are
1010 \c ('*' denotes default):
1011 \c * stabs ELF32 (i386) stabs debug format for Linux
1012 \c dwarf elf32 (i386) dwarf debug format for Linux
1015 \S{opt-pfix} The \i\c{--prefix} and \i\c{--postfix} Options.
1017 The \c{--prefix} and \c{--postfix} options prepend or append
1018 (respectively) the given argument to all \c{global} or
1019 \c{extern} variables. E.g. \c{--prefix _} will prepend the
1020 underscore to all global and external variables, as C requires it in
1021 some, but not all, system calling conventions.
1024 \S{nasmenv} The \i\c{NASMENV} \i{Environment} Variable
1026 If you define an environment variable called \c{NASMENV}, the program
1027 will interpret it as a list of extra command-line options, which are
1028 processed before the real command line. You can use this to define
1029 standard search directories for include files, by putting \c{-i}
1030 options in the \c{NASMENV} variable.
1032 The value of the variable is split up at white space, so that the
1033 value \c{-s -ic:\\nasmlib\\} will be treated as two separate options.
1034 However, that means that the value \c{-dNAME="my name"} won't do
1035 what you might want, because it will be split at the space and the
1036 NASM command-line processing will get confused by the two
1037 nonsensical words \c{-dNAME="my} and \c{name"}.
1039 To get round this, NASM provides a feature whereby, if you begin the
1040 \c{NASMENV} environment variable with some character that isn't a minus
1041 sign, then NASM will treat this character as the \i{separator
1042 character} for options. So setting the \c{NASMENV} variable to the
1043 value \c{!-s!-ic:\\nasmlib\\} is equivalent to setting it to \c{-s
1044 -ic:\\nasmlib\\}, but \c{!-dNAME="my name"} will work.
1046 This environment variable was previously called \c{NASM}. This was
1047 changed with version 0.98.31.
1050 \H{qstart} \i{Quick Start} for \i{MASM} Users
1052 If you're used to writing programs with MASM, or with \i{TASM} in
1053 MASM-compatible (non-Ideal) mode, or with \i\c{a86}, this section
1054 attempts to outline the major differences between MASM's syntax and
1055 NASM's. If you're not already used to MASM, it's probably worth
1056 skipping this section.
1059 \S{qscs} NASM Is \I{case sensitivity}Case-Sensitive
1061 One simple difference is that NASM is case-sensitive. It makes a
1062 difference whether you call your label \c{foo}, \c{Foo} or \c{FOO}.
1063 If you're assembling to \c{DOS} or \c{OS/2} \c{.OBJ} files, you can
1064 invoke the \i\c{UPPERCASE} directive (documented in \k{objfmt}) to
1065 ensure that all symbols exported to other code modules are forced
1066 to be upper case; but even then, \e{within} a single module, NASM
1067 will distinguish between labels differing only in case.
1070 \S{qsbrackets} NASM Requires \i{Square Brackets} For \i{Memory References}
1072 NASM was designed with simplicity of syntax in mind. One of the
1073 \i{design goals} of NASM is that it should be possible, as far as is
1074 practical, for the user to look at a single line of NASM code
1075 and tell what opcode is generated by it. You can't do this in MASM:
1076 if you declare, for example,
1081 then the two lines of code
1086 generate completely different opcodes, despite having
1087 identical-looking syntaxes.
1089 NASM avoids this undesirable situation by having a much simpler
1090 syntax for memory references. The rule is simply that any access to
1091 the \e{contents} of a memory location requires square brackets
1092 around the address, and any access to the \e{address} of a variable
1093 doesn't. So an instruction of the form \c{mov ax,foo} will
1094 \e{always} refer to a compile-time constant, whether it's an \c{EQU}
1095 or the address of a variable; and to access the \e{contents} of the
1096 variable \c{bar}, you must code \c{mov ax,[bar]}.
1098 This also means that NASM has no need for MASM's \i\c{OFFSET}
1099 keyword, since the MASM code \c{mov ax,offset bar} means exactly the
1100 same thing as NASM's \c{mov ax,bar}. If you're trying to get
1101 large amounts of MASM code to assemble sensibly under NASM, you
1102 can always code \c{%idefine offset} to make the preprocessor treat
1103 the \c{OFFSET} keyword as a no-op.
1105 This issue is even more confusing in \i\c{a86}, where declaring a
1106 label with a trailing colon defines it to be a `label' as opposed to
1107 a `variable' and causes \c{a86} to adopt NASM-style semantics; so in
1108 \c{a86}, \c{mov ax,var} has different behaviour depending on whether
1109 \c{var} was declared as \c{var: dw 0} (a label) or \c{var dw 0} (a
1110 word-size variable). NASM is very simple by comparison:
1111 \e{everything} is a label.
1113 NASM, in the interests of simplicity, also does not support the
1114 \i{hybrid syntaxes} supported by MASM and its clones, such as
1115 \c{mov ax,table[bx]}, where a memory reference is denoted by one
1116 portion outside square brackets and another portion inside. The
1117 correct syntax for the above is \c{mov ax,[table+bx]}. Likewise,
1118 \c{mov ax,es:[di]} is wrong and \c{mov ax,[es:di]} is right.
1121 \S{qstypes} NASM Doesn't Store \i{Variable Types}
1123 NASM, by design, chooses not to remember the types of variables you
1124 declare. Whereas MASM will remember, on seeing \c{var dw 0}, that
1125 you declared \c{var} as a word-size variable, and will then be able
1126 to fill in the \i{ambiguity} in the size of the instruction \c{mov
1127 var,2}, NASM will deliberately remember nothing about the symbol
1128 \c{var} except where it begins, and so you must explicitly code
1129 \c{mov word [var],2}.
1131 For this reason, NASM doesn't support the \c{LODS}, \c{MOVS},
1132 \c{STOS}, \c{SCAS}, \c{CMPS}, \c{INS}, or \c{OUTS} instructions,
1133 but only supports the forms such as \c{LODSB}, \c{MOVSW}, and
1134 \c{SCASD}, which explicitly specify the size of the components of
1135 the strings being manipulated.
1138 \S{qsassume} NASM Doesn't \i\c{ASSUME}
1140 As part of NASM's drive for simplicity, it also does not support the
1141 \c{ASSUME} directive. NASM will not keep track of what values you
1142 choose to put in your segment registers, and will never
1143 \e{automatically} generate a \i{segment override} prefix.
1146 \S{qsmodel} NASM Doesn't Support \i{Memory Models}
1148 NASM also does not have any directives to support different 16-bit
1149 memory models. The programmer has to keep track of which functions
1150 are supposed to be called with a \i{far call} and which with a
1151 \i{near call}, and is responsible for putting the correct form of
1152 \c{RET} instruction (\c{RETN} or \c{RETF}; NASM accepts \c{RET}
1153 itself as an alternate form for \c{RETN}); in addition, the
1154 programmer is responsible for coding CALL FAR instructions where
1155 necessary when calling \e{external} functions, and must also keep
1156 track of which external variable definitions are far and which are
1160 \S{qsfpu} \i{Floating-Point} Differences
1162 NASM uses different names to refer to floating-point registers from
1163 MASM: where MASM would call them \c{ST(0)}, \c{ST(1)} and so on, and
1164 \i\c{a86} would call them simply \c{0}, \c{1} and so on, NASM
1165 chooses to call them \c{st0}, \c{st1} etc.
1167 As of version 0.96, NASM now treats the instructions with
1168 \i{`nowait'} forms in the same way as MASM-compatible assemblers.
1169 The idiosyncratic treatment employed by 0.95 and earlier was based
1170 on a misunderstanding by the authors.
1173 \S{qsother} Other Differences
1175 For historical reasons, NASM uses the keyword \i\c{TWORD} where MASM
1176 and compatible assemblers use \i\c{TBYTE}.
1178 NASM does not declare \i{uninitialized storage} in the same way as
1179 MASM: where a MASM programmer might use \c{stack db 64 dup (?)},
1180 NASM requires \c{stack resb 64}, intended to be read as `reserve 64
1181 bytes'. For a limited amount of compatibility, since NASM treats
1182 \c{?} as a valid character in symbol names, you can code \c{? equ 0}
1183 and then writing \c{dw ?} will at least do something vaguely useful.
1184 \I\c{RESB}\i\c{DUP} is still not a supported syntax, however.
1186 In addition to all of this, macros and directives work completely
1187 differently to MASM. See \k{preproc} and \k{directive} for further
1191 \C{lang} The NASM Language
1193 \H{syntax} Layout of a NASM Source Line
1195 Like most assemblers, each NASM source line contains (unless it
1196 is a macro, a preprocessor directive or an assembler directive: see
1197 \k{preproc} and \k{directive}) some combination of the four fields
1199 \c label: instruction operands ; comment
1201 As usual, most of these fields are optional; the presence or absence
1202 of any combination of a label, an instruction and a comment is allowed.
1203 Of course, the operand field is either required or forbidden by the
1204 presence and nature of the instruction field.
1206 NASM uses backslash (\\) as the line continuation character; if a line
1207 ends with backslash, the next line is considered to be a part of the
1208 backslash-ended line.
1210 NASM places no restrictions on white space within a line: labels may
1211 have white space before them, or instructions may have no space
1212 before them, or anything. The \i{colon} after a label is also
1213 optional. (Note that this means that if you intend to code \c{lodsb}
1214 alone on a line, and type \c{lodab} by accident, then that's still a
1215 valid source line which does nothing but define a label. Running
1216 NASM with the command-line option
1217 \I{orphan-labels}\c{-w+orphan-labels} will cause it to warn you if
1218 you define a label alone on a line without a \i{trailing colon}.)
1220 \i{Valid characters} in labels are letters, numbers, \c{_}, \c{$},
1221 \c{#}, \c{@}, \c{~}, \c{.}, and \c{?}. The only characters which may
1222 be used as the \e{first} character of an identifier are letters,
1223 \c{.} (with special meaning: see \k{locallab}), \c{_} and \c{?}.
1224 An identifier may also be prefixed with a \I{$, prefix}\c{$} to
1225 indicate that it is intended to be read as an identifier and not a
1226 reserved word; thus, if some other module you are linking with
1227 defines a symbol called \c{eax}, you can refer to \c{$eax} in NASM
1228 code to distinguish the symbol from the register. Maximum length of
1229 an identifier is 4095 characters.
1231 The instruction field may contain any machine instruction: Pentium
1232 and P6 instructions, FPU instructions, MMX instructions and even
1233 undocumented instructions are all supported. The instruction may be
1234 prefixed by \c{LOCK}, \c{REP}, \c{REPE}/\c{REPZ}, \c{REPNE}/\c{REPNZ},
1235 \c{XACQUIRE}/\c{XRELEASE} or \c{BND}/\c{NOBND}, in the usual way. Explicit
1236 \I{address-size prefixes}address-size and \i{operand-size prefixes} \i\c{A16},
1237 \i\c{A32}, \i\c{A64}, \i\c{O16} and \i\c{O32}, \i\c{O64} are provided - one example of their use
1238 is given in \k{mixsize}. You can also use the name of a \I{segment
1239 override}segment register as an instruction prefix: coding
1240 \c{es mov [bx],ax} is equivalent to coding \c{mov [es:bx],ax}. We
1241 recommend the latter syntax, since it is consistent with other
1242 syntactic features of the language, but for instructions such as
1243 \c{LODSB}, which has no operands and yet can require a segment
1244 override, there is no clean syntactic way to proceed apart from
1247 An instruction is not required to use a prefix: prefixes such as
1248 \c{CS}, \c{A32}, \c{LOCK} or \c{REPE} can appear on a line by
1249 themselves, and NASM will just generate the prefix bytes.
1251 In addition to actual machine instructions, NASM also supports a
1252 number of pseudo-instructions, described in \k{pseudop}.
1254 Instruction \i{operands} may take a number of forms: they can be
1255 registers, described simply by the register name (e.g. \c{ax},
1256 \c{bp}, \c{ebx}, \c{cr0}: NASM does not use the \c{gas}-style
1257 syntax in which register names must be prefixed by a \c{%} sign), or
1258 they can be \i{effective addresses} (see \k{effaddr}), constants
1259 (\k{const}) or expressions (\k{expr}).
1261 For x87 \i{floating-point} instructions, NASM accepts a wide range of
1262 syntaxes: you can use two-operand forms like MASM supports, or you
1263 can use NASM's native single-operand forms in most cases.
1265 \# all forms of each supported instruction are given in
1267 For example, you can code:
1269 \c fadd st1 ; this sets st0 := st0 + st1
1270 \c fadd st0,st1 ; so does this
1272 \c fadd st1,st0 ; this sets st1 := st1 + st0
1273 \c fadd to st1 ; so does this
1275 Almost any x87 floating-point instruction that references memory must
1276 use one of the prefixes \i\c{DWORD}, \i\c{QWORD} or \i\c{TWORD} to
1277 indicate what size of \i{memory operand} it refers to.
1280 \H{pseudop} \i{Pseudo-Instructions}
1282 Pseudo-instructions are things which, though not real x86 machine
1283 instructions, are used in the instruction field anyway because that's
1284 the most convenient place to put them. The current pseudo-instructions
1285 are \i\c{DB}, \i\c{DW}, \i\c{DD}, \i\c{DQ}, \i\c{DT}, \i\c{DO},
1286 \i\c{DY} and \i\c\{DZ}; their \i{uninitialized} counterparts
1287 \i\c{RESB}, \i\c{RESW}, \i\c{RESD}, \i\c{RESQ}, \i\c{REST},
1288 \i\c{RESO}, \i\c{RESY} and \i\c\{RESZ}; the \i\c{INCBIN} command, the
1289 \i\c{EQU} command, and the \i\c{TIMES} prefix.
1292 \S{db} \c{DB} and Friends: Declaring Initialized Data
1294 \i\c{DB}, \i\c{DW}, \i\c{DD}, \i\c{DQ}, \i\c{DT}, \i\c{DO}, \i\c{DY}
1295 and \i\c{DZ} are used, much as in MASM, to declare initialized data in
1296 the output file. They can be invoked in a wide range of ways:
1297 \I{floating-point}\I{character constant}\I{string constant}
1299 \c db 0x55 ; just the byte 0x55
1300 \c db 0x55,0x56,0x57 ; three bytes in succession
1301 \c db 'a',0x55 ; character constants are OK
1302 \c db 'hello',13,10,'$' ; so are string constants
1303 \c dw 0x1234 ; 0x34 0x12
1304 \c dw 'a' ; 0x61 0x00 (it's just a number)
1305 \c dw 'ab' ; 0x61 0x62 (character constant)
1306 \c dw 'abc' ; 0x61 0x62 0x63 0x00 (string)
1307 \c dd 0x12345678 ; 0x78 0x56 0x34 0x12
1308 \c dd 1.234567e20 ; floating-point constant
1309 \c dq 0x123456789abcdef0 ; eight byte constant
1310 \c dq 1.234567e20 ; double-precision float
1311 \c dt 1.234567e20 ; extended-precision float
1313 \c{DT}, \c{DO}, \c{DY} and \c{DZ} do not accept \i{numeric constants}
1317 \S{resb} \c{RESB} and Friends: Declaring \i{Uninitialized} Data
1319 \i\c{RESB}, \i\c{RESW}, \i\c{RESD}, \i\c{RESQ}, \i\c{REST},
1320 \i\c{RESO}, \i\c{RESY} and \i\c\{RESZ} are designed to be used in the
1321 BSS section of a module: they declare \e{uninitialized} storage
1322 space. Each takes a single operand, which is the number of bytes,
1323 words, doublewords or whatever to reserve. As stated in \k{qsother},
1324 NASM does not support the MASM/TASM syntax of reserving uninitialized
1325 space by writing \I\c{?}\c{DW ?} or similar things: this is what it
1326 does instead. The operand to a \c{RESB}-type pseudo-instruction is a
1327 \i\e{critical expression}: see \k{crit}.
1331 \c buffer: resb 64 ; reserve 64 bytes
1332 \c wordvar: resw 1 ; reserve a word
1333 \c realarray resq 10 ; array of ten reals
1334 \c ymmval: resy 1 ; one YMM register
1335 \c zmmvals: resz 32 ; 32 ZMM registers
1337 \S{incbin} \i\c{INCBIN}: Including External \i{Binary Files}
1339 \c{INCBIN} is borrowed from the old Amiga assembler \i{DevPac}: it
1340 includes a binary file verbatim into the output file. This can be
1341 handy for (for example) including \i{graphics} and \i{sound} data
1342 directly into a game executable file. It can be called in one of
1345 \c incbin "file.dat" ; include the whole file
1346 \c incbin "file.dat",1024 ; skip the first 1024 bytes
1347 \c incbin "file.dat",1024,512 ; skip the first 1024, and
1348 \c ; actually include at most 512
1350 \c{INCBIN} is both a directive and a standard macro; the standard
1351 macro version searches for the file in the include file search path
1352 and adds the file to the dependency lists. This macro can be
1353 overridden if desired.
1356 \S{equ} \i\c{EQU}: Defining Constants
1358 \c{EQU} defines a symbol to a given constant value: when \c{EQU} is
1359 used, the source line must contain a label. The action of \c{EQU} is
1360 to define the given label name to the value of its (only) operand.
1361 This definition is absolute, and cannot change later. So, for
1364 \c message db 'hello, world'
1365 \c msglen equ $-message
1367 defines \c{msglen} to be the constant 12. \c{msglen} may not then be
1368 redefined later. This is not a \i{preprocessor} definition either:
1369 the value of \c{msglen} is evaluated \e{once}, using the value of
1370 \c{$} (see \k{expr} for an explanation of \c{$}) at the point of
1371 definition, rather than being evaluated wherever it is referenced
1372 and using the value of \c{$} at the point of reference.
1375 \S{times} \i\c{TIMES}: \i{Repeating} Instructions or Data
1377 The \c{TIMES} prefix causes the instruction to be assembled multiple
1378 times. This is partly present as NASM's equivalent of the \i\c{DUP}
1379 syntax supported by \i{MASM}-compatible assemblers, in that you can
1382 \c zerobuf: times 64 db 0
1384 or similar things; but \c{TIMES} is more versatile than that. The
1385 argument to \c{TIMES} is not just a numeric constant, but a numeric
1386 \e{expression}, so you can do things like
1388 \c buffer: db 'hello, world'
1389 \c times 64-$+buffer db ' '
1391 which will store exactly enough spaces to make the total length of
1392 \c{buffer} up to 64. Finally, \c{TIMES} can be applied to ordinary
1393 instructions, so you can code trivial \i{unrolled loops} in it:
1397 Note that there is no effective difference between \c{times 100 resb
1398 1} and \c{resb 100}, except that the latter will be assembled about
1399 100 times faster due to the internal structure of the assembler.
1401 The operand to \c{TIMES} is a critical expression (\k{crit}).
1403 Note also that \c{TIMES} can't be applied to \i{macros}: the reason
1404 for this is that \c{TIMES} is processed after the macro phase, which
1405 allows the argument to \c{TIMES} to contain expressions such as
1406 \c{64-$+buffer} as above. To repeat more than one line of code, or a
1407 complex macro, use the preprocessor \i\c{%rep} directive.
1410 \H{effaddr} Effective Addresses
1412 An \i{effective address} is any operand to an instruction which
1413 \I{memory reference}references memory. Effective addresses, in NASM,
1414 have a very simple syntax: they consist of an expression evaluating
1415 to the desired address, enclosed in \i{square brackets}. For
1420 \c mov ax,[wordvar+1]
1421 \c mov ax,[es:wordvar+bx]
1423 Anything not conforming to this simple system is not a valid memory
1424 reference in NASM, for example \c{es:wordvar[bx]}.
1426 More complicated effective addresses, such as those involving more
1427 than one register, work in exactly the same way:
1429 \c mov eax,[ebx*2+ecx+offset]
1432 NASM is capable of doing \i{algebra} on these effective addresses,
1433 so that things which don't necessarily \e{look} legal are perfectly
1436 \c mov eax,[ebx*5] ; assembles as [ebx*4+ebx]
1437 \c mov eax,[label1*2-label2] ; ie [label1+(label1-label2)]
1439 Some forms of effective address have more than one assembled form;
1440 in most such cases NASM will generate the smallest form it can. For
1441 example, there are distinct assembled forms for the 32-bit effective
1442 addresses \c{[eax*2+0]} and \c{[eax+eax]}, and NASM will generally
1443 generate the latter on the grounds that the former requires four
1444 bytes to store a zero offset.
1446 NASM has a hinting mechanism which will cause \c{[eax+ebx]} and
1447 \c{[ebx+eax]} to generate different opcodes; this is occasionally
1448 useful because \c{[esi+ebp]} and \c{[ebp+esi]} have different
1449 default segment registers.
1451 However, you can force NASM to generate an effective address in a
1452 particular form by the use of the keywords \c{BYTE}, \c{WORD},
1453 \c{DWORD} and \c{NOSPLIT}. If you need \c{[eax+3]} to be assembled
1454 using a double-word offset field instead of the one byte NASM will
1455 normally generate, you can code \c{[dword eax+3]}. Similarly, you
1456 can force NASM to use a byte offset for a small value which it
1457 hasn't seen on the first pass (see \k{crit} for an example of such a
1458 code fragment) by using \c{[byte eax+offset]}. As special cases,
1459 \c{[byte eax]} will code \c{[eax+0]} with a byte offset of zero, and
1460 \c{[dword eax]} will code it with a double-word offset of zero. The
1461 normal form, \c{[eax]}, will be coded with no offset field.
1463 The form described in the previous paragraph is also useful if you
1464 are trying to access data in a 32-bit segment from within 16 bit code.
1465 For more information on this see the section on mixed-size addressing
1466 (\k{mixaddr}). In particular, if you need to access data with a known
1467 offset that is larger than will fit in a 16-bit value, if you don't
1468 specify that it is a dword offset, nasm will cause the high word of
1469 the offset to be lost.
1471 Similarly, NASM will split \c{[eax*2]} into \c{[eax+eax]} because
1472 that allows the offset field to be absent and space to be saved; in
1473 fact, it will also split \c{[eax*2+offset]} into
1474 \c{[eax+eax+offset]}. You can combat this behaviour by the use of
1475 the \c{NOSPLIT} keyword: \c{[nosplit eax*2]} will force
1476 \c{[eax*2+0]} to be generated literally. \c{[nosplit eax*1]} also has the
1477 same effect. In another way, a split EA form \c{[0, eax*2]} can be used, too.
1478 However, \c{NOSPLIT} in \c{[nosplit eax+eax]} will be ignored because user's
1479 intention here is considered as \c{[eax+eax]}.
1481 In 64-bit mode, NASM will by default generate absolute addresses. The
1482 \i\c{REL} keyword makes it produce \c{RIP}-relative addresses. Since
1483 this is frequently the normally desired behaviour, see the \c{DEFAULT}
1484 directive (\k{default}). The keyword \i\c{ABS} overrides \i\c{REL}.
1486 A new form of split effective addres syntax is also supported. This is
1487 mainly intended for mib operands as used by MPX instructions, but can
1488 be used for any memory reference. The basic concept of this form is
1489 splitting base and index.
1491 \c mov eax,[ebx+8,ecx*4] ; ebx=base, ecx=index, 4=scale, 8=disp
1493 For mib operands, there are several ways of writing effective address depending
1494 on the tools. NASM supports all currently possible ways of mib syntax:
1497 \c ; next 5 lines are parsed same
1498 \c ; base=rax, index=rbx, scale=1, displacement=3
1499 \c bndstx [rax+0x3,rbx], bnd0 ; NASM - split EA
1500 \c bndstx [rbx*1+rax+0x3], bnd0 ; GAS - '*1' indecates an index reg
1501 \c bndstx [rax+rbx+3], bnd0 ; GAS - without hints
1502 \c bndstx [rax+0x3], bnd0, rbx ; ICC-1
1503 \c bndstx [rax+0x3], rbx, bnd0 ; ICC-2
1505 When broadcasting decorator is used, the opsize keyword should match
1506 the size of each element.
1508 \c VDIVPS zmm4, zmm5, dword [rbx]{1to16} ; single-precision float
1509 \c VDIVPS zmm4, zmm5, zword [rbx] ; packed 512 bit memory
1512 \H{const} \i{Constants}
1514 NASM understands four different types of constant: numeric,
1515 character, string and floating-point.
1518 \S{numconst} \i{Numeric Constants}
1520 A numeric constant is simply a number. NASM allows you to specify
1521 numbers in a variety of number bases, in a variety of ways: you can
1522 suffix \c{H} or \c{X}, \c{D} or \c{T}, \c{Q} or \c{O}, and \c{B} or
1523 \c{Y} for \i{hexadecimal}, \i{decimal}, \i{octal} and \i{binary}
1524 respectively, or you can prefix \c{0x}, for hexadecimal in the style
1525 of C, or you can prefix \c{$} for hexadecimal in the style of Borland
1526 Pascal or Motorola Assemblers. Note, though, that the \I{$,
1527 prefix}\c{$} prefix does double duty as a prefix on identifiers (see
1528 \k{syntax}), so a hex number prefixed with a \c{$} sign must have a
1529 digit after the \c{$} rather than a letter. In addition, current
1530 versions of NASM accept the prefix \c{0h} for hexadecimal, \c{0d} or
1531 \c{0t} for decimal, \c{0o} or \c{0q} for octal, and \c{0b} or \c{0y}
1532 for binary. Please note that unlike C, a \c{0} prefix by itself does
1533 \e{not} imply an octal constant!
1535 Numeric constants can have underscores (\c{_}) interspersed to break
1538 Some examples (all producing exactly the same code):
1540 \c mov ax,200 ; decimal
1541 \c mov ax,0200 ; still decimal
1542 \c mov ax,0200d ; explicitly decimal
1543 \c mov ax,0d200 ; also decimal
1544 \c mov ax,0c8h ; hex
1545 \c mov ax,$0c8 ; hex again: the 0 is required
1546 \c mov ax,0xc8 ; hex yet again
1547 \c mov ax,0hc8 ; still hex
1548 \c mov ax,310q ; octal
1549 \c mov ax,310o ; octal again
1550 \c mov ax,0o310 ; octal yet again
1551 \c mov ax,0q310 ; octal yet again
1552 \c mov ax,11001000b ; binary
1553 \c mov ax,1100_1000b ; same binary constant
1554 \c mov ax,1100_1000y ; same binary constant once more
1555 \c mov ax,0b1100_1000 ; same binary constant yet again
1556 \c mov ax,0y1100_1000 ; same binary constant yet again
1558 \S{strings} \I{Strings}\i{Character Strings}
1560 A character string consists of up to eight characters enclosed in
1561 either single quotes (\c{'...'}), double quotes (\c{"..."}) or
1562 backquotes (\c{`...`}). Single or double quotes are equivalent to
1563 NASM (except of course that surrounding the constant with single
1564 quotes allows double quotes to appear within it and vice versa); the
1565 contents of those are represented verbatim. Strings enclosed in
1566 backquotes support C-style \c{\\}-escapes for special characters.
1569 The following \i{escape sequences} are recognized by backquoted strings:
1571 \c \' single quote (')
1572 \c \" double quote (")
1574 \c \\\ backslash (\)
1575 \c \? question mark (?)
1583 \c \e ESC (ASCII 27)
1584 \c \377 Up to 3 octal digits - literal byte
1585 \c \xFF Up to 2 hexadecimal digits - literal byte
1586 \c \u1234 4 hexadecimal digits - Unicode character
1587 \c \U12345678 8 hexadecimal digits - Unicode character
1589 All other escape sequences are reserved. Note that \c{\\0}, meaning a
1590 \c{NUL} character (ASCII 0), is a special case of the octal escape
1593 \i{Unicode} characters specified with \c{\\u} or \c{\\U} are converted to
1594 \i{UTF-8}. For example, the following lines are all equivalent:
1596 \c db `\u263a` ; UTF-8 smiley face
1597 \c db `\xe2\x98\xba` ; UTF-8 smiley face
1598 \c db 0E2h, 098h, 0BAh ; UTF-8 smiley face
1601 \S{chrconst} \i{Character Constants}
1603 A character constant consists of a string up to eight bytes long, used
1604 in an expression context. It is treated as if it was an integer.
1606 A character constant with more than one byte will be arranged
1607 with \i{little-endian} order in mind: if you code
1611 then the constant generated is not \c{0x61626364}, but
1612 \c{0x64636261}, so that if you were then to store the value into
1613 memory, it would read \c{abcd} rather than \c{dcba}. This is also
1614 the sense of character constants understood by the Pentium's
1615 \i\c{CPUID} instruction.
1618 \S{strconst} \i{String Constants}
1620 String constants are character strings used in the context of some
1621 pseudo-instructions, namely the
1622 \I\c{DW}\I\c{DD}\I\c{DQ}\I\c{DT}\I\c{DO}\I\c{DY}\i\c{DB} family and
1623 \i\c{INCBIN} (where it represents a filename.) They are also used in
1624 certain preprocessor directives.
1626 A string constant looks like a character constant, only longer. It
1627 is treated as a concatenation of maximum-size character constants
1628 for the conditions. So the following are equivalent:
1630 \c db 'hello' ; string constant
1631 \c db 'h','e','l','l','o' ; equivalent character constants
1633 And the following are also equivalent:
1635 \c dd 'ninechars' ; doubleword string constant
1636 \c dd 'nine','char','s' ; becomes three doublewords
1637 \c db 'ninechars',0,0,0 ; and really looks like this
1639 Note that when used in a string-supporting context, quoted strings are
1640 treated as a string constants even if they are short enough to be a
1641 character constant, because otherwise \c{db 'ab'} would have the same
1642 effect as \c{db 'a'}, which would be silly. Similarly, three-character
1643 or four-character constants are treated as strings when they are
1644 operands to \c{DW}, and so forth.
1646 \S{unicode} \I{UTF-16}\I{UTF-32}\i{Unicode} Strings
1648 The special operators \i\c{__utf16__}, \i\c{__utf16le__},
1649 \i\c{__utf16be__}, \i\c{__utf32__}, \i\c{__utf32le__} and
1650 \i\c{__utf32be__} allows definition of Unicode strings. They take a
1651 string in UTF-8 format and converts it to UTF-16 or UTF-32,
1652 respectively. Unless the \c{be} forms are specified, the output is
1657 \c %define u(x) __utf16__(x)
1658 \c %define w(x) __utf32__(x)
1660 \c dw u('C:\WINDOWS'), 0 ; Pathname in UTF-16
1661 \c dd w(`A + B = \u206a`), 0 ; String in UTF-32
1663 The UTF operators can be applied either to strings passed to the
1664 \c{DB} family instructions, or to character constants in an expression
1667 \S{fltconst} \I{floating-point, constants}Floating-Point Constants
1669 \i{Floating-point} constants are acceptable only as arguments to
1670 \i\c{DB}, \i\c{DW}, \i\c{DD}, \i\c{DQ}, \i\c{DT}, and \i\c{DO}, or as
1671 arguments to the special operators \i\c{__float8__},
1672 \i\c{__float16__}, \i\c{__float32__}, \i\c{__float64__},
1673 \i\c{__float80m__}, \i\c{__float80e__}, \i\c{__float128l__}, and
1674 \i\c{__float128h__}.
1676 Floating-point constants are expressed in the traditional form:
1677 digits, then a period, then optionally more digits, then optionally an
1678 \c{E} followed by an exponent. The period is mandatory, so that NASM
1679 can distinguish between \c{dd 1}, which declares an integer constant,
1680 and \c{dd 1.0} which declares a floating-point constant.
1682 NASM also support C99-style hexadecimal floating-point: \c{0x},
1683 hexadecimal digits, period, optionally more hexadeximal digits, then
1684 optionally a \c{P} followed by a \e{binary} (not hexadecimal) exponent
1685 in decimal notation. As an extension, NASM additionally supports the
1686 \c{0h} and \c{$} prefixes for hexadecimal, as well binary and octal
1687 floating-point, using the \c{0b} or \c{0y} and \c{0o} or \c{0q}
1688 prefixes, respectively.
1690 Underscores to break up groups of digits are permitted in
1691 floating-point constants as well.
1695 \c db -0.2 ; "Quarter precision"
1696 \c dw -0.5 ; IEEE 754r/SSE5 half precision
1697 \c dd 1.2 ; an easy one
1698 \c dd 1.222_222_222 ; underscores are permitted
1699 \c dd 0x1p+2 ; 1.0x2^2 = 4.0
1700 \c dq 0x1p+32 ; 1.0x2^32 = 4 294 967 296.0
1701 \c dq 1.e10 ; 10 000 000 000.0
1702 \c dq 1.e+10 ; synonymous with 1.e10
1703 \c dq 1.e-10 ; 0.000 000 000 1
1704 \c dt 3.141592653589793238462 ; pi
1705 \c do 1.e+4000 ; IEEE 754r quad precision
1707 The 8-bit "quarter-precision" floating-point format is
1708 sign:exponent:mantissa = 1:4:3 with an exponent bias of 7. This
1709 appears to be the most frequently used 8-bit floating-point format,
1710 although it is not covered by any formal standard. This is sometimes
1711 called a "\i{minifloat}."
1713 The special operators are used to produce floating-point numbers in
1714 other contexts. They produce the binary representation of a specific
1715 floating-point number as an integer, and can use anywhere integer
1716 constants are used in an expression. \c{__float80m__} and
1717 \c{__float80e__} produce the 64-bit mantissa and 16-bit exponent of an
1718 80-bit floating-point number, and \c{__float128l__} and
1719 \c{__float128h__} produce the lower and upper 64-bit halves of a 128-bit
1720 floating-point number, respectively.
1724 \c mov rax,__float64__(3.141592653589793238462)
1726 ... would assign the binary representation of pi as a 64-bit floating
1727 point number into \c{RAX}. This is exactly equivalent to:
1729 \c mov rax,0x400921fb54442d18
1731 NASM cannot do compile-time arithmetic on floating-point constants.
1732 This is because NASM is designed to be portable - although it always
1733 generates code to run on x86 processors, the assembler itself can
1734 run on any system with an ANSI C compiler. Therefore, the assembler
1735 cannot guarantee the presence of a floating-point unit capable of
1736 handling the \i{Intel number formats}, and so for NASM to be able to
1737 do floating arithmetic it would have to include its own complete set
1738 of floating-point routines, which would significantly increase the
1739 size of the assembler for very little benefit.
1741 The special tokens \i\c{__Infinity__}, \i\c{__QNaN__} (or
1742 \i\c{__NaN__}) and \i\c{__SNaN__} can be used to generate
1743 \I{infinity}infinities, quiet \i{NaN}s, and signalling NaNs,
1744 respectively. These are normally used as macros:
1746 \c %define Inf __Infinity__
1747 \c %define NaN __QNaN__
1749 \c dq +1.5, -Inf, NaN ; Double-precision constants
1751 The \c{%use fp} standard macro package contains a set of convenience
1752 macros. See \k{pkg_fp}.
1754 \S{bcdconst} \I{floating-point, packed BCD constants}Packed BCD Constants
1756 x87-style packed BCD constants can be used in the same contexts as
1757 80-bit floating-point numbers. They are suffixed with \c{p} or
1758 prefixed with \c{0p}, and can include up to 18 decimal digits.
1760 As with other numeric constants, underscores can be used to separate
1765 \c dt 12_345_678_901_245_678p
1766 \c dt -12_345_678_901_245_678p
1771 \H{expr} \i{Expressions}
1773 Expressions in NASM are similar in syntax to those in C. Expressions
1774 are evaluated as 64-bit integers which are then adjusted to the
1777 NASM supports two special tokens in expressions, allowing
1778 calculations to involve the current assembly position: the
1779 \I{$, here}\c{$} and \i\c{$$} tokens. \c{$} evaluates to the assembly
1780 position at the beginning of the line containing the expression; so
1781 you can code an \i{infinite loop} using \c{JMP $}. \c{$$} evaluates
1782 to the beginning of the current section; so you can tell how far
1783 into the section you are by using \c{($-$$)}.
1785 The arithmetic \i{operators} provided by NASM are listed here, in
1786 increasing order of \i{precedence}.
1789 \S{expor} \i\c{|}: \i{Bitwise OR} Operator
1791 The \c{|} operator gives a bitwise OR, exactly as performed by the
1792 \c{OR} machine instruction. Bitwise OR is the lowest-priority
1793 arithmetic operator supported by NASM.
1796 \S{expxor} \i\c{^}: \i{Bitwise XOR} Operator
1798 \c{^} provides the bitwise XOR operation.
1801 \S{expand} \i\c{&}: \i{Bitwise AND} Operator
1803 \c{&} provides the bitwise AND operation.
1806 \S{expshift} \i\c{<<} and \i\c{>>}: \i{Bit Shift} Operators
1808 \c{<<} gives a bit-shift to the left, just as it does in C. So \c{5<<3}
1809 evaluates to 5 times 8, or 40. \c{>>} gives a bit-shift to the
1810 right; in NASM, such a shift is \e{always} unsigned, so that
1811 the bits shifted in from the left-hand end are filled with zero
1812 rather than a sign-extension of the previous highest bit.
1815 \S{expplmi} \I{+ opaddition}\c{+} and \I{- opsubtraction}\c{-}:
1816 \i{Addition} and \i{Subtraction} Operators
1818 The \c{+} and \c{-} operators do perfectly ordinary addition and
1822 \S{expmul} \i\c{*}, \i\c{/}, \i\c{//}, \i\c{%} and \i\c{%%}:
1823 \i{Multiplication} and \i{Division}
1825 \c{*} is the multiplication operator. \c{/} and \c{//} are both
1826 division operators: \c{/} is \i{unsigned division} and \c{//} is
1827 \i{signed division}. Similarly, \c{%} and \c{%%} provide \I{unsigned
1828 modulo}\I{modulo operators}unsigned and
1829 \i{signed modulo} operators respectively.
1831 NASM, like ANSI C, provides no guarantees about the sensible
1832 operation of the signed modulo operator.
1834 Since the \c{%} character is used extensively by the macro
1835 \i{preprocessor}, you should ensure that both the signed and unsigned
1836 modulo operators are followed by white space wherever they appear.
1839 \S{expmul} \i{Unary Operators}
1841 The highest-priority operators in NASM's expression grammar are those
1842 which only apply to one argument. These are \I{+ opunary}\c{+}, \I{-
1843 opunary}\c{-}, \i\c{~}, \I{! opunary}\c{!}, \i\c{SEG}, and the
1844 \i{integer functions} operators.
1846 \c{-} negates its operand, \c{+} does nothing (it's provided for
1847 symmetry with \c{-}), \c{~} computes the \i{one's complement} of its
1848 operand, \c{!} is the \i{logical negation} operator.
1850 \c{SEG} provides the \i{segment address}
1851 of its operand (explained in more detail in \k{segwrt}).
1853 A set of additional operators with leading and trailing double
1854 underscores are used to implement the integer functions of the
1855 \c{ifunc} macro package, see \k{pkg_ifunc}.
1858 \H{segwrt} \i\c{SEG} and \i\c{WRT}
1860 When writing large 16-bit programs, which must be split into
1861 multiple \i{segments}, it is often necessary to be able to refer to
1862 the \I{segment address}segment part of the address of a symbol. NASM
1863 supports the \c{SEG} operator to perform this function.
1865 The \c{SEG} operator returns the \i\e{preferred} segment base of a
1866 symbol, defined as the segment base relative to which the offset of
1867 the symbol makes sense. So the code
1869 \c mov ax,seg symbol
1873 will load \c{ES:BX} with a valid pointer to the symbol \c{symbol}.
1875 Things can be more complex than this: since 16-bit segments and
1876 \i{groups} may \I{overlapping segments}overlap, you might occasionally
1877 want to refer to some symbol using a different segment base from the
1878 preferred one. NASM lets you do this, by the use of the \c{WRT}
1879 (With Reference To) keyword. So you can do things like
1881 \c mov ax,weird_seg ; weird_seg is a segment base
1883 \c mov bx,symbol wrt weird_seg
1885 to load \c{ES:BX} with a different, but functionally equivalent,
1886 pointer to the symbol \c{symbol}.
1888 NASM supports far (inter-segment) calls and jumps by means of the
1889 syntax \c{call segment:offset}, where \c{segment} and \c{offset}
1890 both represent immediate values. So to call a far procedure, you
1891 could code either of
1893 \c call (seg procedure):procedure
1894 \c call weird_seg:(procedure wrt weird_seg)
1896 (The parentheses are included for clarity, to show the intended
1897 parsing of the above instructions. They are not necessary in
1900 NASM supports the syntax \I\c{CALL FAR}\c{call far procedure} as a
1901 synonym for the first of the above usages. \c{JMP} works identically
1902 to \c{CALL} in these examples.
1904 To declare a \i{far pointer} to a data item in a data segment, you
1907 \c dw symbol, seg symbol
1909 NASM supports no convenient synonym for this, though you can always
1910 invent one using the macro processor.
1913 \H{strict} \i\c{STRICT}: Inhibiting Optimization
1915 When assembling with the optimizer set to level 2 or higher (see
1916 \k{opt-O}), NASM will use size specifiers (\c{BYTE}, \c{WORD},
1917 \c{DWORD}, \c{QWORD}, \c{TWORD}, \c{OWORD}, \c{YWORD} or \c{ZWORD}),
1918 but will give them the smallest possible size. The keyword \c{STRICT}
1919 can be used to inhibit optimization and force a particular operand to
1920 be emitted in the specified size. For example, with the optimizer on,
1921 and in \c{BITS 16} mode,
1925 is encoded in three bytes \c{66 6A 21}, whereas
1927 \c push strict dword 33
1929 is encoded in six bytes, with a full dword immediate operand \c{66 68
1932 With the optimizer off, the same code (six bytes) is generated whether
1933 the \c{STRICT} keyword was used or not.
1936 \H{crit} \i{Critical Expressions}
1938 Although NASM has an optional multi-pass optimizer, there are some
1939 expressions which must be resolvable on the first pass. These are
1940 called \e{Critical Expressions}.
1942 The first pass is used to determine the size of all the assembled
1943 code and data, so that the second pass, when generating all the
1944 code, knows all the symbol addresses the code refers to. So one
1945 thing NASM can't handle is code whose size depends on the value of a
1946 symbol declared after the code in question. For example,
1948 \c times (label-$) db 0
1949 \c label: db 'Where am I?'
1951 The argument to \i\c{TIMES} in this case could equally legally
1952 evaluate to anything at all; NASM will reject this example because
1953 it cannot tell the size of the \c{TIMES} line when it first sees it.
1954 It will just as firmly reject the slightly \I{paradox}paradoxical
1957 \c times (label-$+1) db 0
1958 \c label: db 'NOW where am I?'
1960 in which \e{any} value for the \c{TIMES} argument is by definition
1963 NASM rejects these examples by means of a concept called a
1964 \e{critical expression}, which is defined to be an expression whose
1965 value is required to be computable in the first pass, and which must
1966 therefore depend only on symbols defined before it. The argument to
1967 the \c{TIMES} prefix is a critical expression.
1969 \H{locallab} \i{Local Labels}
1971 NASM gives special treatment to symbols beginning with a \i{period}.
1972 A label beginning with a single period is treated as a \e{local}
1973 label, which means that it is associated with the previous non-local
1974 label. So, for example:
1976 \c label1 ; some code
1984 \c label2 ; some code
1992 In the above code fragment, each \c{JNE} instruction jumps to the
1993 line immediately before it, because the two definitions of \c{.loop}
1994 are kept separate by virtue of each being associated with the
1995 previous non-local label.
1997 This form of local label handling is borrowed from the old Amiga
1998 assembler \i{DevPac}; however, NASM goes one step further, in
1999 allowing access to local labels from other parts of the code. This
2000 is achieved by means of \e{defining} a local label in terms of the
2001 previous non-local label: the first definition of \c{.loop} above is
2002 really defining a symbol called \c{label1.loop}, and the second
2003 defines a symbol called \c{label2.loop}. So, if you really needed
2006 \c label3 ; some more code
2011 Sometimes it is useful - in a macro, for instance - to be able to
2012 define a label which can be referenced from anywhere but which
2013 doesn't interfere with the normal local-label mechanism. Such a
2014 label can't be non-local because it would interfere with subsequent
2015 definitions of, and references to, local labels; and it can't be
2016 local because the macro that defined it wouldn't know the label's
2017 full name. NASM therefore introduces a third type of label, which is
2018 probably only useful in macro definitions: if a label begins with
2019 the \I{label prefix}special prefix \i\c{..@}, then it does nothing
2020 to the local label mechanism. So you could code
2022 \c label1: ; a non-local label
2023 \c .local: ; this is really label1.local
2024 \c ..@foo: ; this is a special symbol
2025 \c label2: ; another non-local label
2026 \c .local: ; this is really label2.local
2028 \c jmp ..@foo ; this will jump three lines up
2030 NASM has the capacity to define other special symbols beginning with
2031 a double period: for example, \c{..start} is used to specify the
2032 entry point in the \c{obj} output format (see \k{dotdotstart}),
2033 \c{..imagebase} is used to find out the offset from a base address
2034 of the current image in the \c{win64} output format (see \k{win64pic}).
2035 So just keep in mind that symbols beginning with a double period are
2039 \C{preproc} The NASM \i{Preprocessor}
2041 NASM contains a powerful \i{macro processor}, which supports
2042 conditional assembly, multi-level file inclusion, two forms of macro
2043 (single-line and multi-line), and a `context stack' mechanism for
2044 extra macro power. Preprocessor directives all begin with a \c{%}
2047 The preprocessor collapses all lines which end with a backslash (\\)
2048 character into a single line. Thus:
2050 \c %define THIS_VERY_LONG_MACRO_NAME_IS_DEFINED_TO \\
2053 will work like a single-line macro without the backslash-newline
2056 \H{slmacro} \i{Single-Line Macros}
2058 \S{define} The Normal Way: \I\c{%idefine}\i\c{%define}
2060 Single-line macros are defined using the \c{%define} preprocessor
2061 directive. The definitions work in a similar way to C; so you can do
2064 \c %define ctrl 0x1F &
2065 \c %define param(a,b) ((a)+(a)*(b))
2067 \c mov byte [param(2,ebx)], ctrl 'D'
2069 which will expand to
2071 \c mov byte [(2)+(2)*(ebx)], 0x1F & 'D'
2073 When the expansion of a single-line macro contains tokens which
2074 invoke another macro, the expansion is performed at invocation time,
2075 not at definition time. Thus the code
2077 \c %define a(x) 1+b(x)
2082 will evaluate in the expected way to \c{mov ax,1+2*8}, even though
2083 the macro \c{b} wasn't defined at the time of definition of \c{a}.
2085 Macros defined with \c{%define} are \i{case sensitive}: after
2086 \c{%define foo bar}, only \c{foo} will expand to \c{bar}: \c{Foo} or
2087 \c{FOO} will not. By using \c{%idefine} instead of \c{%define} (the
2088 `i' stands for `insensitive') you can define all the case variants
2089 of a macro at once, so that \c{%idefine foo bar} would cause
2090 \c{foo}, \c{Foo}, \c{FOO}, \c{fOO} and so on all to expand to
2093 There is a mechanism which detects when a macro call has occurred as
2094 a result of a previous expansion of the same macro, to guard against
2095 \i{circular references} and infinite loops. If this happens, the
2096 preprocessor will only expand the first occurrence of the macro.
2099 \c %define a(x) 1+a(x)
2103 the macro \c{a(3)} will expand once, becoming \c{1+a(3)}, and will
2104 then expand no further. This behaviour can be useful: see \k{32c}
2105 for an example of its use.
2107 You can \I{overloading, single-line macros}overload single-line
2108 macros: if you write
2110 \c %define foo(x) 1+x
2111 \c %define foo(x,y) 1+x*y
2113 the preprocessor will be able to handle both types of macro call,
2114 by counting the parameters you pass; so \c{foo(3)} will become
2115 \c{1+3} whereas \c{foo(ebx,2)} will become \c{1+ebx*2}. However, if
2120 then no other definition of \c{foo} will be accepted: a macro with
2121 no parameters prohibits the definition of the same name as a macro
2122 \e{with} parameters, and vice versa.
2124 This doesn't prevent single-line macros being \e{redefined}: you can
2125 perfectly well define a macro with
2129 and then re-define it later in the same source file with
2133 Then everywhere the macro \c{foo} is invoked, it will be expanded
2134 according to the most recent definition. This is particularly useful
2135 when defining single-line macros with \c{%assign} (see \k{assign}).
2137 You can \i{pre-define} single-line macros using the `-d' option on
2138 the NASM command line: see \k{opt-d}.
2141 \S{xdefine} Resolving \c{%define}: \I\c{%ixdefine}\i\c{%xdefine}
2143 To have a reference to an embedded single-line macro resolved at the
2144 time that the embedding macro is \e{defined}, as opposed to when the
2145 embedding macro is \e{expanded}, you need a different mechanism to the
2146 one offered by \c{%define}. The solution is to use \c{%xdefine}, or
2147 it's \I{case sensitive}case-insensitive counterpart \c{%ixdefine}.
2149 Suppose you have the following code:
2152 \c %define isFalse isTrue
2161 In this case, \c{val1} is equal to 0, and \c{val2} is equal to 1.
2162 This is because, when a single-line macro is defined using
2163 \c{%define}, it is expanded only when it is called. As \c{isFalse}
2164 expands to \c{isTrue}, the expansion will be the current value of
2165 \c{isTrue}. The first time it is called that is 0, and the second
2168 If you wanted \c{isFalse} to expand to the value assigned to the
2169 embedded macro \c{isTrue} at the time that \c{isFalse} was defined,
2170 you need to change the above code to use \c{%xdefine}.
2172 \c %xdefine isTrue 1
2173 \c %xdefine isFalse isTrue
2174 \c %xdefine isTrue 0
2178 \c %xdefine isTrue 1
2182 Now, each time that \c{isFalse} is called, it expands to 1,
2183 as that is what the embedded macro \c{isTrue} expanded to at
2184 the time that \c{isFalse} was defined.
2187 \S{indmacro} \i{Macro Indirection}: \I\c{%[}\c{%[...]}
2189 The \c{%[...]} construct can be used to expand macros in contexts
2190 where macro expansion would otherwise not occur, including in the
2191 names other macros. For example, if you have a set of macros named
2192 \c{Foo16}, \c{Foo32} and \c{Foo64}, you could write:
2194 \c mov ax,Foo%[__BITS__] ; The Foo value
2196 to use the builtin macro \c{__BITS__} (see \k{bitsm}) to automatically
2197 select between them. Similarly, the two statements:
2199 \c %xdefine Bar Quux ; Expands due to %xdefine
2200 \c %define Bar %[Quux] ; Expands due to %[...]
2202 have, in fact, exactly the same effect.
2204 \c{%[...]} concatenates to adjacent tokens in the same way that
2205 multi-line macro parameters do, see \k{concat} for details.
2208 \S{concat%+} Concatenating Single Line Macro Tokens: \i\c{%+}
2210 Individual tokens in single line macros can be concatenated, to produce
2211 longer tokens for later processing. This can be useful if there are
2212 several similar macros that perform similar functions.
2214 Please note that a space is required after \c{%+}, in order to
2215 disambiguate it from the syntax \c{%+1} used in multiline macros.
2217 As an example, consider the following:
2219 \c %define BDASTART 400h ; Start of BIOS data area
2221 \c struc tBIOSDA ; its structure
2227 Now, if we need to access the elements of tBIOSDA in different places,
2230 \c mov ax,BDASTART + tBIOSDA.COM1addr
2231 \c mov bx,BDASTART + tBIOSDA.COM2addr
2233 This will become pretty ugly (and tedious) if used in many places, and
2234 can be reduced in size significantly by using the following macro:
2236 \c ; Macro to access BIOS variables by their names (from tBDA):
2238 \c %define BDA(x) BDASTART + tBIOSDA. %+ x
2240 Now the above code can be written as:
2242 \c mov ax,BDA(COM1addr)
2243 \c mov bx,BDA(COM2addr)
2245 Using this feature, we can simplify references to a lot of macros (and,
2246 in turn, reduce typing errors).
2249 \S{selfref%?} The Macro Name Itself: \i\c{%?} and \i\c{%??}
2251 The special symbols \c{%?} and \c{%??} can be used to reference the
2252 macro name itself inside a macro expansion, this is supported for both
2253 single-and multi-line macros. \c{%?} refers to the macro name as
2254 \e{invoked}, whereas \c{%??} refers to the macro name as
2255 \e{declared}. The two are always the same for case-sensitive
2256 macros, but for case-insensitive macros, they can differ.
2260 \c %idefine Foo mov %?,%??
2272 \c %idefine keyword $%?
2274 can be used to make a keyword "disappear", for example in case a new
2275 instruction has been used as a label in older code. For example:
2277 \c %idefine pause $%? ; Hide the PAUSE instruction
2280 \S{undef} Undefining Single-Line Macros: \i\c{%undef}
2282 Single-line macros can be removed with the \c{%undef} directive. For
2283 example, the following sequence:
2290 will expand to the instruction \c{mov eax, foo}, since after
2291 \c{%undef} the macro \c{foo} is no longer defined.
2293 Macros that would otherwise be pre-defined can be undefined on the
2294 command-line using the `-u' option on the NASM command line: see
2298 \S{assign} \i{Preprocessor Variables}: \i\c{%assign}
2300 An alternative way to define single-line macros is by means of the
2301 \c{%assign} command (and its \I{case sensitive}case-insensitive
2302 counterpart \i\c{%iassign}, which differs from \c{%assign} in
2303 exactly the same way that \c{%idefine} differs from \c{%define}).
2305 \c{%assign} is used to define single-line macros which take no
2306 parameters and have a numeric value. This value can be specified in
2307 the form of an expression, and it will be evaluated once, when the
2308 \c{%assign} directive is processed.
2310 Like \c{%define}, macros defined using \c{%assign} can be re-defined
2311 later, so you can do things like
2315 to increment the numeric value of a macro.
2317 \c{%assign} is useful for controlling the termination of \c{%rep}
2318 preprocessor loops: see \k{rep} for an example of this. Another
2319 use for \c{%assign} is given in \k{16c} and \k{32c}.
2321 The expression passed to \c{%assign} is a \i{critical expression}
2322 (see \k{crit}), and must also evaluate to a pure number (rather than
2323 a relocatable reference such as a code or data address, or anything
2324 involving a register).
2327 \S{defstr} Defining Strings: \I\c{%idefstr}\i\c{%defstr}
2329 \c{%defstr}, and its case-insensitive counterpart \c{%idefstr}, define
2330 or redefine a single-line macro without parameters but converts the
2331 entire right-hand side, after macro expansion, to a quoted string
2336 \c %defstr test TEST
2340 \c %define test 'TEST'
2342 This can be used, for example, with the \c{%!} construct (see
2345 \c %defstr PATH %!PATH ; The operating system PATH variable
2348 \S{deftok} Defining Tokens: \I\c{%ideftok}\i\c{%deftok}
2350 \c{%deftok}, and its case-insensitive counterpart \c{%ideftok}, define
2351 or redefine a single-line macro without parameters but converts the
2352 second parameter, after string conversion, to a sequence of tokens.
2356 \c %deftok test 'TEST'
2360 \c %define test TEST
2363 \H{strlen} \i{String Manipulation in Macros}
2365 It's often useful to be able to handle strings in macros. NASM
2366 supports a few simple string handling macro operators from which
2367 more complex operations can be constructed.
2369 All the string operators define or redefine a value (either a string
2370 or a numeric value) to a single-line macro. When producing a string
2371 value, it may change the style of quoting of the input string or
2372 strings, and possibly use \c{\\}-escapes inside \c{`}-quoted strings.
2374 \S{strcat} \i{Concatenating Strings}: \i\c{%strcat}
2376 The \c{%strcat} operator concatenates quoted strings and assign them to
2377 a single-line macro.
2381 \c %strcat alpha "Alpha: ", '12" screen'
2383 ... would assign the value \c{'Alpha: 12" screen'} to \c{alpha}.
2386 \c %strcat beta '"foo"\', "'bar'"
2388 ... would assign the value \c{`"foo"\\\\'bar'`} to \c{beta}.
2390 The use of commas to separate strings is permitted but optional.
2393 \S{strlen} \i{String Length}: \i\c{%strlen}
2395 The \c{%strlen} operator assigns the length of a string to a macro.
2398 \c %strlen charcnt 'my string'
2400 In this example, \c{charcnt} would receive the value 9, just as
2401 if an \c{%assign} had been used. In this example, \c{'my string'}
2402 was a literal string but it could also have been a single-line
2403 macro that expands to a string, as in the following example:
2405 \c %define sometext 'my string'
2406 \c %strlen charcnt sometext
2408 As in the first case, this would result in \c{charcnt} being
2409 assigned the value of 9.
2412 \S{substr} \i{Extracting Substrings}: \i\c{%substr}
2414 Individual letters or substrings in strings can be extracted using the
2415 \c{%substr} operator. An example of its use is probably more useful
2416 than the description:
2418 \c %substr mychar 'xyzw' 1 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'x'
2419 \c %substr mychar 'xyzw' 2 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'y'
2420 \c %substr mychar 'xyzw' 3 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'z'
2421 \c %substr mychar 'xyzw' 2,2 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'yz'
2422 \c %substr mychar 'xyzw' 2,-1 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'yzw'
2423 \c %substr mychar 'xyzw' 2,-2 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'yz'
2425 As with \c{%strlen} (see \k{strlen}), the first parameter is the
2426 single-line macro to be created and the second is the string. The
2427 third parameter specifies the first character to be selected, and the
2428 optional fourth parameter preceeded by comma) is the length. Note
2429 that the first index is 1, not 0 and the last index is equal to the
2430 value that \c{%strlen} would assign given the same string. Index
2431 values out of range result in an empty string. A negative length
2432 means "until N-1 characters before the end of string", i.e. \c{-1}
2433 means until end of string, \c{-2} until one character before, etc.
2436 \H{mlmacro} \i{Multi-Line Macros}: \I\c{%imacro}\i\c{%macro}
2438 Multi-line macros are much more like the type of macro seen in MASM
2439 and TASM: a multi-line macro definition in NASM looks something like
2442 \c %macro prologue 1
2450 This defines a C-like function prologue as a macro: so you would
2451 invoke the macro with a call such as
2453 \c myfunc: prologue 12
2455 which would expand to the three lines of code
2461 The number \c{1} after the macro name in the \c{%macro} line defines
2462 the number of parameters the macro \c{prologue} expects to receive.
2463 The use of \c{%1} inside the macro definition refers to the first
2464 parameter to the macro call. With a macro taking more than one
2465 parameter, subsequent parameters would be referred to as \c{%2},
2468 Multi-line macros, like single-line macros, are \i{case-sensitive},
2469 unless you define them using the alternative directive \c{%imacro}.
2471 If you need to pass a comma as \e{part} of a parameter to a
2472 multi-line macro, you can do that by enclosing the entire parameter
2473 in \I{braces, around macro parameters}braces. So you could code
2482 \c silly 'a', letter_a ; letter_a: db 'a'
2483 \c silly 'ab', string_ab ; string_ab: db 'ab'
2484 \c silly {13,10}, crlf ; crlf: db 13,10
2487 \S{mlmacover} Overloading Multi-Line Macros\I{overloading, multi-line macros}
2489 As with single-line macros, multi-line macros can be overloaded by
2490 defining the same macro name several times with different numbers of
2491 parameters. This time, no exception is made for macros with no
2492 parameters at all. So you could define
2494 \c %macro prologue 0
2501 to define an alternative form of the function prologue which
2502 allocates no local stack space.
2504 Sometimes, however, you might want to `overload' a machine
2505 instruction; for example, you might want to define
2514 so that you could code
2516 \c push ebx ; this line is not a macro call
2517 \c push eax,ecx ; but this one is
2519 Ordinarily, NASM will give a warning for the first of the above two
2520 lines, since \c{push} is now defined to be a macro, and is being
2521 invoked with a number of parameters for which no definition has been
2522 given. The correct code will still be generated, but the assembler
2523 will give a warning. This warning can be disabled by the use of the
2524 \c{-w-macro-params} command-line option (see \k{opt-w}).
2527 \S{maclocal} \i{Macro-Local Labels}
2529 NASM allows you to define labels within a multi-line macro
2530 definition in such a way as to make them local to the macro call: so
2531 calling the same macro multiple times will use a different label
2532 each time. You do this by prefixing \i\c{%%} to the label name. So
2533 you can invent an instruction which executes a \c{RET} if the \c{Z}
2534 flag is set by doing this:
2544 You can call this macro as many times as you want, and every time
2545 you call it NASM will make up a different `real' name to substitute
2546 for the label \c{%%skip}. The names NASM invents are of the form
2547 \c{..@2345.skip}, where the number 2345 changes with every macro
2548 call. The \i\c{..@} prefix prevents macro-local labels from
2549 interfering with the local label mechanism, as described in
2550 \k{locallab}. You should avoid defining your own labels in this form
2551 (the \c{..@} prefix, then a number, then another period) in case
2552 they interfere with macro-local labels.
2555 \S{mlmacgre} \i{Greedy Macro Parameters}
2557 Occasionally it is useful to define a macro which lumps its entire
2558 command line into one parameter definition, possibly after
2559 extracting one or two smaller parameters from the front. An example
2560 might be a macro to write a text string to a file in MS-DOS, where
2561 you might want to be able to write
2563 \c writefile [filehandle],"hello, world",13,10
2565 NASM allows you to define the last parameter of a macro to be
2566 \e{greedy}, meaning that if you invoke the macro with more
2567 parameters than it expects, all the spare parameters get lumped into
2568 the last defined one along with the separating commas. So if you
2571 \c %macro writefile 2+
2577 \c mov cx,%%endstr-%%str
2584 then the example call to \c{writefile} above will work as expected:
2585 the text before the first comma, \c{[filehandle]}, is used as the
2586 first macro parameter and expanded when \c{%1} is referred to, and
2587 all the subsequent text is lumped into \c{%2} and placed after the
2590 The greedy nature of the macro is indicated to NASM by the use of
2591 the \I{+ modifier}\c{+} sign after the parameter count on the
2594 If you define a greedy macro, you are effectively telling NASM how
2595 it should expand the macro given \e{any} number of parameters from
2596 the actual number specified up to infinity; in this case, for
2597 example, NASM now knows what to do when it sees a call to
2598 \c{writefile} with 2, 3, 4 or more parameters. NASM will take this
2599 into account when overloading macros, and will not allow you to
2600 define another form of \c{writefile} taking 4 parameters (for
2603 Of course, the above macro could have been implemented as a
2604 non-greedy macro, in which case the call to it would have had to
2607 \c writefile [filehandle], {"hello, world",13,10}
2609 NASM provides both mechanisms for putting \i{commas in macro
2610 parameters}, and you choose which one you prefer for each macro
2613 See \k{sectmac} for a better way to write the above macro.
2615 \S{mlmacrange} \i{Macro Parameters Range}
2617 NASM allows you to expand parameters via special construction \c{%\{x:y\}}
2618 where \c{x} is the first parameter index and \c{y} is the last. Any index can
2619 be either negative or positive but must never be zero.
2629 expands to \c{3,4,5} range.
2631 Even more, the parameters can be reversed so that
2639 expands to \c{5,4,3} range.
2641 But even this is not the last. The parameters can be addressed via negative
2642 indices so NASM will count them reversed. The ones who know Python may see
2651 expands to \c{6,5,4} range.
2653 Note that NASM uses \i{comma} to separate parameters being expanded.
2655 By the way, here is a trick - you might use the index \c{%{-1:-1}}
2656 which gives you the \i{last} argument passed to a macro.
2658 \S{mlmacdef} \i{Default Macro Parameters}
2660 NASM also allows you to define a multi-line macro with a \e{range}
2661 of allowable parameter counts. If you do this, you can specify
2662 defaults for \i{omitted parameters}. So, for example:
2664 \c %macro die 0-1 "Painful program death has occurred."
2672 This macro (which makes use of the \c{writefile} macro defined in
2673 \k{mlmacgre}) can be called with an explicit error message, which it
2674 will display on the error output stream before exiting, or it can be
2675 called with no parameters, in which case it will use the default
2676 error message supplied in the macro definition.
2678 In general, you supply a minimum and maximum number of parameters
2679 for a macro of this type; the minimum number of parameters are then
2680 required in the macro call, and then you provide defaults for the
2681 optional ones. So if a macro definition began with the line
2683 \c %macro foobar 1-3 eax,[ebx+2]
2685 then it could be called with between one and three parameters, and
2686 \c{%1} would always be taken from the macro call. \c{%2}, if not
2687 specified by the macro call, would default to \c{eax}, and \c{%3} if
2688 not specified would default to \c{[ebx+2]}.
2690 You can provide extra information to a macro by providing
2691 too many default parameters:
2693 \c %macro quux 1 something
2695 This will trigger a warning by default; see \k{opt-w} for
2697 When \c{quux} is invoked, it receives not one but two parameters.
2698 \c{something} can be referred to as \c{%2}. The difference
2699 between passing \c{something} this way and writing \c{something}
2700 in the macro body is that with this way \c{something} is evaluated
2701 when the macro is defined, not when it is expanded.
2703 You may omit parameter defaults from the macro definition, in which
2704 case the parameter default is taken to be blank. This can be useful
2705 for macros which can take a variable number of parameters, since the
2706 \i\c{%0} token (see \k{percent0}) allows you to determine how many
2707 parameters were really passed to the macro call.
2709 This defaulting mechanism can be combined with the greedy-parameter
2710 mechanism; so the \c{die} macro above could be made more powerful,
2711 and more useful, by changing the first line of the definition to
2713 \c %macro die 0-1+ "Painful program death has occurred.",13,10
2715 The maximum parameter count can be infinite, denoted by \c{*}. In
2716 this case, of course, it is impossible to provide a \e{full} set of
2717 default parameters. Examples of this usage are shown in \k{rotate}.
2720 \S{percent0} \i\c{%0}: \I{counting macro parameters}Macro Parameter Counter
2722 The parameter reference \c{%0} will return a numeric constant giving the
2723 number of parameters received, that is, if \c{%0} is n then \c{%}n is the
2724 last parameter. \c{%0} is mostly useful for macros that can take a variable
2725 number of parameters. It can be used as an argument to \c{%rep}
2726 (see \k{rep}) in order to iterate through all the parameters of a macro.
2727 Examples are given in \k{rotate}.
2730 \S{percent00} \i\c{%00}: \I{label preceeding macro}Label Preceeding Macro
2732 \c{%00} will return the label preceeding the macro invocation, if any. The
2733 label must be on the same line as the macro invocation, may be a local label
2734 (see \k{locallab}), and need not end in a colon.
2737 \S{rotate} \i\c{%rotate}: \i{Rotating Macro Parameters}
2739 Unix shell programmers will be familiar with the \I{shift
2740 command}\c{shift} shell command, which allows the arguments passed
2741 to a shell script (referenced as \c{$1}, \c{$2} and so on) to be
2742 moved left by one place, so that the argument previously referenced
2743 as \c{$2} becomes available as \c{$1}, and the argument previously
2744 referenced as \c{$1} is no longer available at all.
2746 NASM provides a similar mechanism, in the form of \c{%rotate}. As
2747 its name suggests, it differs from the Unix \c{shift} in that no
2748 parameters are lost: parameters rotated off the left end of the
2749 argument list reappear on the right, and vice versa.
2751 \c{%rotate} is invoked with a single numeric argument (which may be
2752 an expression). The macro parameters are rotated to the left by that
2753 many places. If the argument to \c{%rotate} is negative, the macro
2754 parameters are rotated to the right.
2756 \I{iterating over macro parameters}So a pair of macros to save and
2757 restore a set of registers might work as follows:
2759 \c %macro multipush 1-*
2768 This macro invokes the \c{PUSH} instruction on each of its arguments
2769 in turn, from left to right. It begins by pushing its first
2770 argument, \c{%1}, then invokes \c{%rotate} to move all the arguments
2771 one place to the left, so that the original second argument is now
2772 available as \c{%1}. Repeating this procedure as many times as there
2773 were arguments (achieved by supplying \c{%0} as the argument to
2774 \c{%rep}) causes each argument in turn to be pushed.
2776 Note also the use of \c{*} as the maximum parameter count,
2777 indicating that there is no upper limit on the number of parameters
2778 you may supply to the \i\c{multipush} macro.
2780 It would be convenient, when using this macro, to have a \c{POP}
2781 equivalent, which \e{didn't} require the arguments to be given in
2782 reverse order. Ideally, you would write the \c{multipush} macro
2783 call, then cut-and-paste the line to where the pop needed to be
2784 done, and change the name of the called macro to \c{multipop}, and
2785 the macro would take care of popping the registers in the opposite
2786 order from the one in which they were pushed.
2788 This can be done by the following definition:
2790 \c %macro multipop 1-*
2799 This macro begins by rotating its arguments one place to the
2800 \e{right}, so that the original \e{last} argument appears as \c{%1}.
2801 This is then popped, and the arguments are rotated right again, so
2802 the second-to-last argument becomes \c{%1}. Thus the arguments are
2803 iterated through in reverse order.
2806 \S{concat} \i{Concatenating Macro Parameters}
2808 NASM can concatenate macro parameters and macro indirection constructs
2809 on to other text surrounding them. This allows you to declare a family
2810 of symbols, for example, in a macro definition. If, for example, you
2811 wanted to generate a table of key codes along with offsets into the
2812 table, you could code something like
2814 \c %macro keytab_entry 2
2816 \c keypos%1 equ $-keytab
2822 \c keytab_entry F1,128+1
2823 \c keytab_entry F2,128+2
2824 \c keytab_entry Return,13
2826 which would expand to
2829 \c keyposF1 equ $-keytab
2831 \c keyposF2 equ $-keytab
2833 \c keyposReturn equ $-keytab
2836 You can just as easily concatenate text on to the other end of a
2837 macro parameter, by writing \c{%1foo}.
2839 If you need to append a \e{digit} to a macro parameter, for example
2840 defining labels \c{foo1} and \c{foo2} when passed the parameter
2841 \c{foo}, you can't code \c{%11} because that would be taken as the
2842 eleventh macro parameter. Instead, you must code
2843 \I{braces, after % sign}\c{%\{1\}1}, which will separate the first
2844 \c{1} (giving the number of the macro parameter) from the second
2845 (literal text to be concatenated to the parameter).
2847 This concatenation can also be applied to other preprocessor in-line
2848 objects, such as macro-local labels (\k{maclocal}) and context-local
2849 labels (\k{ctxlocal}). In all cases, ambiguities in syntax can be
2850 resolved by enclosing everything after the \c{%} sign and before the
2851 literal text in braces: so \c{%\{%foo\}bar} concatenates the text
2852 \c{bar} to the end of the real name of the macro-local label
2853 \c{%%foo}. (This is unnecessary, since the form NASM uses for the
2854 real names of macro-local labels means that the two usages
2855 \c{%\{%foo\}bar} and \c{%%foobar} would both expand to the same
2856 thing anyway; nevertheless, the capability is there.)
2858 The single-line macro indirection construct, \c{%[...]}
2859 (\k{indmacro}), behaves the same way as macro parameters for the
2860 purpose of concatenation.
2862 See also the \c{%+} operator, \k{concat%+}.
2865 \S{mlmaccc} \i{Condition Codes as Macro Parameters}
2867 NASM can give special treatment to a macro parameter which contains
2868 a condition code. For a start, you can refer to the macro parameter
2869 \c{%1} by means of the alternative syntax \i\c{%+1}, which informs
2870 NASM that this macro parameter is supposed to contain a condition
2871 code, and will cause the preprocessor to report an error message if
2872 the macro is called with a parameter which is \e{not} a valid
2875 Far more usefully, though, you can refer to the macro parameter by
2876 means of \i\c{%-1}, which NASM will expand as the \e{inverse}
2877 condition code. So the \c{retz} macro defined in \k{maclocal} can be
2878 replaced by a general \i{conditional-return macro} like this:
2888 This macro can now be invoked using calls like \c{retc ne}, which
2889 will cause the conditional-jump instruction in the macro expansion
2890 to come out as \c{JE}, or \c{retc po} which will make the jump a
2893 The \c{%+1} macro-parameter reference is quite happy to interpret
2894 the arguments \c{CXZ} and \c{ECXZ} as valid condition codes;
2895 however, \c{%-1} will report an error if passed either of these,
2896 because no inverse condition code exists.
2899 \S{nolist} \i{Disabling Listing Expansion}\I\c{.nolist}
2901 When NASM is generating a listing file from your program, it will
2902 generally expand multi-line macros by means of writing the macro
2903 call and then listing each line of the expansion. This allows you to
2904 see which instructions in the macro expansion are generating what
2905 code; however, for some macros this clutters the listing up
2908 NASM therefore provides the \c{.nolist} qualifier, which you can
2909 include in a macro definition to inhibit the expansion of the macro
2910 in the listing file. The \c{.nolist} qualifier comes directly after
2911 the number of parameters, like this:
2913 \c %macro foo 1.nolist
2917 \c %macro bar 1-5+.nolist a,b,c,d,e,f,g,h
2919 \S{unmacro} Undefining Multi-Line Macros: \i\c{%unmacro}
2921 Multi-line macros can be removed with the \c{%unmacro} directive.
2922 Unlike the \c{%undef} directive, however, \c{%unmacro} takes an
2923 argument specification, and will only remove \i{exact matches} with
2924 that argument specification.
2933 removes the previously defined macro \c{foo}, but
2940 does \e{not} remove the macro \c{bar}, since the argument
2941 specification does not match exactly.
2944 \H{condasm} \i{Conditional Assembly}\I\c{%if}
2946 Similarly to the C preprocessor, NASM allows sections of a source
2947 file to be assembled only if certain conditions are met. The general
2948 syntax of this feature looks like this:
2951 \c ; some code which only appears if <condition> is met
2952 \c %elif<condition2>
2953 \c ; only appears if <condition> is not met but <condition2> is
2955 \c ; this appears if neither <condition> nor <condition2> was met
2958 The inverse forms \i\c{%ifn} and \i\c{%elifn} are also supported.
2960 The \i\c{%else} clause is optional, as is the \i\c{%elif} clause.
2961 You can have more than one \c{%elif} clause as well.
2963 There are a number of variants of the \c{%if} directive. Each has its
2964 corresponding \c{%elif}, \c{%ifn}, and \c{%elifn} directives; for
2965 example, the equivalents to the \c{%ifdef} directive are \c{%elifdef},
2966 \c{%ifndef}, and \c{%elifndef}.
2968 \S{ifdef} \i\c{%ifdef}: Testing Single-Line Macro Existence\I{testing,
2969 single-line macro existence}
2971 Beginning a conditional-assembly block with the line \c{%ifdef
2972 MACRO} will assemble the subsequent code if, and only if, a
2973 single-line macro called \c{MACRO} is defined. If not, then the
2974 \c{%elif} and \c{%else} blocks (if any) will be processed instead.
2976 For example, when debugging a program, you might want to write code
2979 \c ; perform some function
2981 \c writefile 2,"Function performed successfully",13,10
2983 \c ; go and do something else
2985 Then you could use the command-line option \c{-dDEBUG} to create a
2986 version of the program which produced debugging messages, and remove
2987 the option to generate the final release version of the program.
2989 You can test for a macro \e{not} being defined by using
2990 \i\c{%ifndef} instead of \c{%ifdef}. You can also test for macro
2991 definitions in \c{%elif} blocks by using \i\c{%elifdef} and
2995 \S{ifmacro} \i\c{%ifmacro}: Testing Multi-Line Macro
2996 Existence\I{testing, multi-line macro existence}
2998 The \c{%ifmacro} directive operates in the same way as the \c{%ifdef}
2999 directive, except that it checks for the existence of a multi-line macro.
3001 For example, you may be working with a large project and not have control
3002 over the macros in a library. You may want to create a macro with one
3003 name if it doesn't already exist, and another name if one with that name
3006 The \c{%ifmacro} is considered true if defining a macro with the given name
3007 and number of arguments would cause a definitions conflict. For example:
3009 \c %ifmacro MyMacro 1-3
3011 \c %error "MyMacro 1-3" causes a conflict with an existing macro.
3015 \c %macro MyMacro 1-3
3017 \c ; insert code to define the macro
3023 This will create the macro "MyMacro 1-3" if no macro already exists which
3024 would conflict with it, and emits a warning if there would be a definition
3027 You can test for the macro not existing by using the \i\c{%ifnmacro} instead
3028 of \c{%ifmacro}. Additional tests can be performed in \c{%elif} blocks by using
3029 \i\c{%elifmacro} and \i\c{%elifnmacro}.
3032 \S{ifctx} \i\c{%ifctx}: Testing the Context Stack\I{testing, context
3035 The conditional-assembly construct \c{%ifctx} will cause the
3036 subsequent code to be assembled if and only if the top context on
3037 the preprocessor's context stack has the same name as one of the arguments.
3038 As with \c{%ifdef}, the inverse and \c{%elif} forms \i\c{%ifnctx},
3039 \i\c{%elifctx} and \i\c{%elifnctx} are also supported.
3041 For more details of the context stack, see \k{ctxstack}. For a
3042 sample use of \c{%ifctx}, see \k{blockif}.
3045 \S{if} \i\c{%if}: Testing Arbitrary Numeric Expressions\I{testing,
3046 arbitrary numeric expressions}
3048 The conditional-assembly construct \c{%if expr} will cause the
3049 subsequent code to be assembled if and only if the value of the
3050 numeric expression \c{expr} is non-zero. An example of the use of
3051 this feature is in deciding when to break out of a \c{%rep}
3052 preprocessor loop: see \k{rep} for a detailed example.
3054 The expression given to \c{%if}, and its counterpart \i\c{%elif}, is
3055 a critical expression (see \k{crit}).
3057 \c{%if} extends the normal NASM expression syntax, by providing a
3058 set of \i{relational operators} which are not normally available in
3059 expressions. The operators \i\c{=}, \i\c{<}, \i\c{>}, \i\c{<=},
3060 \i\c{>=} and \i\c{<>} test equality, less-than, greater-than,
3061 less-or-equal, greater-or-equal and not-equal respectively. The
3062 C-like forms \i\c{==} and \i\c{!=} are supported as alternative
3063 forms of \c{=} and \c{<>}. In addition, low-priority logical
3064 operators \i\c{&&}, \i\c{^^} and \i\c{||} are provided, supplying
3065 \i{logical AND}, \i{logical XOR} and \i{logical OR}. These work like
3066 the C logical operators (although C has no logical XOR), in that
3067 they always return either 0 or 1, and treat any non-zero input as 1
3068 (so that \c{^^}, for example, returns 1 if exactly one of its inputs
3069 is zero, and 0 otherwise). The relational operators also return 1
3070 for true and 0 for false.
3072 Like other \c{%if} constructs, \c{%if} has a counterpart
3073 \i\c{%elif}, and negative forms \i\c{%ifn} and \i\c{%elifn}.
3075 \S{ifidn} \i\c{%ifidn} and \i\c{%ifidni}: Testing Exact Text
3076 Identity\I{testing, exact text identity}
3078 The construct \c{%ifidn text1,text2} will cause the subsequent code
3079 to be assembled if and only if \c{text1} and \c{text2}, after
3080 expanding single-line macros, are identical pieces of text.
3081 Differences in white space are not counted.
3083 \c{%ifidni} is similar to \c{%ifidn}, but is \i{case-insensitive}.
3085 For example, the following macro pushes a register or number on the
3086 stack, and allows you to treat \c{IP} as a real register:
3088 \c %macro pushparam 1
3099 Like other \c{%if} constructs, \c{%ifidn} has a counterpart
3100 \i\c{%elifidn}, and negative forms \i\c{%ifnidn} and \i\c{%elifnidn}.
3101 Similarly, \c{%ifidni} has counterparts \i\c{%elifidni},
3102 \i\c{%ifnidni} and \i\c{%elifnidni}.
3104 \S{iftyp} \i\c{%ifid}, \i\c{%ifnum}, \i\c{%ifstr}: Testing Token
3105 Types\I{testing, token types}
3107 Some macros will want to perform different tasks depending on
3108 whether they are passed a number, a string, or an identifier. For
3109 example, a string output macro might want to be able to cope with
3110 being passed either a string constant or a pointer to an existing
3113 The conditional assembly construct \c{%ifid}, taking one parameter
3114 (which may be blank), assembles the subsequent code if and only if
3115 the first token in the parameter exists and is an identifier.
3116 \c{%ifnum} works similarly, but tests for the token being a numeric
3117 constant; \c{%ifstr} tests for it being a string.
3119 For example, the \c{writefile} macro defined in \k{mlmacgre} can be
3120 extended to take advantage of \c{%ifstr} in the following fashion:
3122 \c %macro writefile 2-3+
3131 \c %%endstr: mov dx,%%str
3132 \c mov cx,%%endstr-%%str
3143 Then the \c{writefile} macro can cope with being called in either of
3144 the following two ways:
3146 \c writefile [file], strpointer, length
3147 \c writefile [file], "hello", 13, 10
3149 In the first, \c{strpointer} is used as the address of an
3150 already-declared string, and \c{length} is used as its length; in
3151 the second, a string is given to the macro, which therefore declares
3152 it itself and works out the address and length for itself.
3154 Note the use of \c{%if} inside the \c{%ifstr}: this is to detect
3155 whether the macro was passed two arguments (so the string would be a
3156 single string constant, and \c{db %2} would be adequate) or more (in
3157 which case, all but the first two would be lumped together into
3158 \c{%3}, and \c{db %2,%3} would be required).
3160 The usual \I\c{%elifid}\I\c{%elifnum}\I\c{%elifstr}\c{%elif}...,
3161 \I\c{%ifnid}\I\c{%ifnnum}\I\c{%ifnstr}\c{%ifn}..., and
3162 \I\c{%elifnid}\I\c{%elifnnum}\I\c{%elifnstr}\c{%elifn}... versions
3163 exist for each of \c{%ifid}, \c{%ifnum} and \c{%ifstr}.
3165 \S{iftoken} \i\c{%iftoken}: Test for a Single Token
3167 Some macros will want to do different things depending on if it is
3168 passed a single token (e.g. paste it to something else using \c{%+})
3169 versus a multi-token sequence.
3171 The conditional assembly construct \c{%iftoken} assembles the
3172 subsequent code if and only if the expanded parameters consist of
3173 exactly one token, possibly surrounded by whitespace.
3179 will assemble the subsequent code, but
3183 will not, since \c{-1} contains two tokens: the unary minus operator
3184 \c{-}, and the number \c{1}.
3186 The usual \i\c{%eliftoken}, \i\c\{%ifntoken}, and \i\c{%elifntoken}
3187 variants are also provided.
3189 \S{ifempty} \i\c{%ifempty}: Test for Empty Expansion
3191 The conditional assembly construct \c{%ifempty} assembles the
3192 subsequent code if and only if the expanded parameters do not contain
3193 any tokens at all, whitespace excepted.
3195 The usual \i\c{%elifempty}, \i\c\{%ifnempty}, and \i\c{%elifnempty}
3196 variants are also provided.
3198 \S{ifenv} \i\c{%ifenv}: Test If Environment Variable Exists
3200 The conditional assembly construct \c{%ifenv} assembles the
3201 subsequent code if and only if the environment variable referenced by
3202 the \c{%!<env>} directive exists.
3204 The usual \i\c{%elifenv}, \i\c\{%ifnenv}, and \i\c{%elifnenv}
3205 variants are also provided.
3207 Just as for \c{%!<env>} the argument should be written as a string if
3208 it contains characters that would not be legal in an identifier. See
3211 \H{rep} \i{Preprocessor Loops}\I{repeating code}: \i\c{%rep}
3213 NASM's \c{TIMES} prefix, though useful, cannot be used to invoke a
3214 multi-line macro multiple times, because it is processed by NASM
3215 after macros have already been expanded. Therefore NASM provides
3216 another form of loop, this time at the preprocessor level: \c{%rep}.
3218 The directives \c{%rep} and \i\c{%endrep} (\c{%rep} takes a numeric
3219 argument, which can be an expression; \c{%endrep} takes no
3220 arguments) can be used to enclose a chunk of code, which is then
3221 replicated as many times as specified by the preprocessor:
3225 \c inc word [table+2*i]
3229 This will generate a sequence of 64 \c{INC} instructions,
3230 incrementing every word of memory from \c{[table]} to
3233 For more complex termination conditions, or to break out of a repeat
3234 loop part way along, you can use the \i\c{%exitrep} directive to
3235 terminate the loop, like this:
3250 \c fib_number equ ($-fibonacci)/2
3252 This produces a list of all the Fibonacci numbers that will fit in
3253 16 bits. Note that a maximum repeat count must still be given to
3254 \c{%rep}. This is to prevent the possibility of NASM getting into an
3255 infinite loop in the preprocessor, which (on multitasking or
3256 multi-user systems) would typically cause all the system memory to
3257 be gradually used up and other applications to start crashing.
3259 Note a maximum repeat count is limited by 62 bit number, though it
3260 is hardly possible that you ever need anything bigger.
3263 \H{files} Source Files and Dependencies
3265 These commands allow you to split your sources into multiple files.
3267 \S{include} \i\c{%include}: \i{Including Other Files}
3269 Using, once again, a very similar syntax to the C preprocessor,
3270 NASM's preprocessor lets you include other source files into your
3271 code. This is done by the use of the \i\c{%include} directive:
3273 \c %include "macros.mac"
3275 will include the contents of the file \c{macros.mac} into the source
3276 file containing the \c{%include} directive.
3278 Include files are \I{searching for include files}searched for in the
3279 current directory (the directory you're in when you run NASM, as
3280 opposed to the location of the NASM executable or the location of
3281 the source file), plus any directories specified on the NASM command
3282 line using the \c{-i} option.
3284 The standard C idiom for preventing a file being included more than
3285 once is just as applicable in NASM: if the file \c{macros.mac} has
3288 \c %ifndef MACROS_MAC
3289 \c %define MACROS_MAC
3290 \c ; now define some macros
3293 then including the file more than once will not cause errors,
3294 because the second time the file is included nothing will happen
3295 because the macro \c{MACROS_MAC} will already be defined.
3297 You can force a file to be included even if there is no \c{%include}
3298 directive that explicitly includes it, by using the \i\c{-p} option
3299 on the NASM command line (see \k{opt-p}).
3302 \S{pathsearch} \i\c{%pathsearch}: Search the Include Path
3304 The \c{%pathsearch} directive takes a single-line macro name and a
3305 filename, and declare or redefines the specified single-line macro to
3306 be the include-path-resolved version of the filename, if the file
3307 exists (otherwise, it is passed unchanged.)
3311 \c %pathsearch MyFoo "foo.bin"
3313 ... with \c{-Ibins/} in the include path may end up defining the macro
3314 \c{MyFoo} to be \c{"bins/foo.bin"}.
3317 \S{depend} \i\c{%depend}: Add Dependent Files
3319 The \c{%depend} directive takes a filename and adds it to the list of
3320 files to be emitted as dependency generation when the \c{-M} options
3321 and its relatives (see \k{opt-M}) are used. It produces no output.
3323 This is generally used in conjunction with \c{%pathsearch}. For
3324 example, a simplified version of the standard macro wrapper for the
3325 \c{INCBIN} directive looks like:
3327 \c %imacro incbin 1-2+ 0
3328 \c %pathsearch dep %1
3333 This first resolves the location of the file into the macro \c{dep},
3334 then adds it to the dependency lists, and finally issues the
3335 assembler-level \c{INCBIN} directive.
3338 \S{use} \i\c{%use}: Include Standard Macro Package
3340 The \c{%use} directive is similar to \c{%include}, but rather than
3341 including the contents of a file, it includes a named standard macro
3342 package. The standard macro packages are part of NASM, and are
3343 described in \k{macropkg}.
3345 Unlike the \c{%include} directive, package names for the \c{%use}
3346 directive do not require quotes, but quotes are permitted. In NASM
3347 2.04 and 2.05 the unquoted form would be macro-expanded; this is no
3348 longer true. Thus, the following lines are equivalent:
3353 Standard macro packages are protected from multiple inclusion. When a
3354 standard macro package is used, a testable single-line macro of the
3355 form \c{__USE_}\e{package}\c{__} is also defined, see \k{use_def}.
3357 \H{ctxstack} The \i{Context Stack}
3359 Having labels that are local to a macro definition is sometimes not
3360 quite powerful enough: sometimes you want to be able to share labels
3361 between several macro calls. An example might be a \c{REPEAT} ...
3362 \c{UNTIL} loop, in which the expansion of the \c{REPEAT} macro
3363 would need to be able to refer to a label which the \c{UNTIL} macro
3364 had defined. However, for such a macro you would also want to be
3365 able to nest these loops.
3367 NASM provides this level of power by means of a \e{context stack}.
3368 The preprocessor maintains a stack of \e{contexts}, each of which is
3369 characterized by a name. You add a new context to the stack using
3370 the \i\c{%push} directive, and remove one using \i\c{%pop}. You can
3371 define labels that are local to a particular context on the stack.
3374 \S{pushpop} \i\c{%push} and \i\c{%pop}: \I{creating
3375 contexts}\I{removing contexts}Creating and Removing Contexts
3377 The \c{%push} directive is used to create a new context and place it
3378 on the top of the context stack. \c{%push} takes an optional argument,
3379 which is the name of the context. For example:
3383 This pushes a new context called \c{foobar} on the stack. You can have
3384 several contexts on the stack with the same name: they can still be
3385 distinguished. If no name is given, the context is unnamed (this is
3386 normally used when both the \c{%push} and the \c{%pop} are inside a
3387 single macro definition.)
3389 The directive \c{%pop}, taking one optional argument, removes the top
3390 context from the context stack and destroys it, along with any
3391 labels associated with it. If an argument is given, it must match the
3392 name of the current context, otherwise it will issue an error.
3395 \S{ctxlocal} \i{Context-Local Labels}
3397 Just as the usage \c{%%foo} defines a label which is local to the
3398 particular macro call in which it is used, the usage \I{%$}\c{%$foo}
3399 is used to define a label which is local to the context on the top
3400 of the context stack. So the \c{REPEAT} and \c{UNTIL} example given
3401 above could be implemented by means of:
3417 and invoked by means of, for example,
3425 which would scan every fourth byte of a string in search of the byte
3428 If you need to define, or access, labels local to the context
3429 \e{below} the top one on the stack, you can use \I{%$$}\c{%$$foo}, or
3430 \c{%$$$foo} for the context below that, and so on.
3433 \S{ctxdefine} \i{Context-Local Single-Line Macros}
3435 NASM also allows you to define single-line macros which are local to
3436 a particular context, in just the same way:
3438 \c %define %$localmac 3
3440 will define the single-line macro \c{%$localmac} to be local to the
3441 top context on the stack. Of course, after a subsequent \c{%push},
3442 it can then still be accessed by the name \c{%$$localmac}.
3445 \S{ctxfallthrough} \i{Context Fall-Through Lookup}
3447 Context fall-through lookup (automatic searching of outer contexts)
3448 is a feature that was added in NASM version 0.98.03. Unfortunately,
3449 this feature is unintuitive and can result in buggy code that would
3450 have otherwise been prevented by NASM's error reporting. As a result,
3451 this feature has been \e{deprecated}. NASM version 2.09 will issue a
3452 warning when usage of this \e{deprecated} feature is detected. Starting
3453 with NASM version 2.10, usage of this \e{deprecated} feature will simply
3454 result in an \e{expression syntax error}.
3456 An example usage of this \e{deprecated} feature follows:
3460 \c %assign %$external 1
3462 \c %assign %$internal 1
3463 \c mov eax, %$external
3464 \c mov eax, %$internal
3469 As demonstrated, \c{%$external} is being defined in the \c{ctx1}
3470 context and referenced within the \c{ctx2} context. With context
3471 fall-through lookup, referencing an undefined context-local macro
3472 like this implicitly searches through all outer contexts until a match
3473 is made or isn't found in any context. As a result, \c{%$external}
3474 referenced within the \c{ctx2} context would implicitly use \c{%$external}
3475 as defined in \c{ctx1}. Most people would expect NASM to issue an error in
3476 this situation because \c{%$external} was never defined within \c{ctx2} and also
3477 isn't qualified with the proper context depth, \c{%$$external}.
3479 Here is a revision of the above example with proper context depth:
3483 \c %assign %$external 1
3485 \c %assign %$internal 1
3486 \c mov eax, %$$external
3487 \c mov eax, %$internal
3492 As demonstrated, \c{%$external} is still being defined in the \c{ctx1}
3493 context and referenced within the \c{ctx2} context. However, the
3494 reference to \c{%$external} within \c{ctx2} has been fully qualified with
3495 the proper context depth, \c{%$$external}, and thus is no longer ambiguous,
3496 unintuitive or erroneous.
3499 \S{ctxrepl} \i\c{%repl}: \I{renaming contexts}Renaming a Context
3501 If you need to change the name of the top context on the stack (in
3502 order, for example, to have it respond differently to \c{%ifctx}),
3503 you can execute a \c{%pop} followed by a \c{%push}; but this will
3504 have the side effect of destroying all context-local labels and
3505 macros associated with the context that was just popped.
3507 NASM provides the directive \c{%repl}, which \e{replaces} a context
3508 with a different name, without touching the associated macros and
3509 labels. So you could replace the destructive code
3514 with the non-destructive version \c{%repl newname}.
3517 \S{blockif} Example Use of the \i{Context Stack}: \i{Block IFs}
3519 This example makes use of almost all the context-stack features,
3520 including the conditional-assembly construct \i\c{%ifctx}, to
3521 implement a block IF statement as a set of macros.
3537 \c %error "expected `if' before `else'"
3551 \c %error "expected `if' or `else' before `endif'"
3556 This code is more robust than the \c{REPEAT} and \c{UNTIL} macros
3557 given in \k{ctxlocal}, because it uses conditional assembly to check
3558 that the macros are issued in the right order (for example, not
3559 calling \c{endif} before \c{if}) and issues a \c{%error} if they're
3562 In addition, the \c{endif} macro has to be able to cope with the two
3563 distinct cases of either directly following an \c{if}, or following
3564 an \c{else}. It achieves this, again, by using conditional assembly
3565 to do different things depending on whether the context on top of
3566 the stack is \c{if} or \c{else}.
3568 The \c{else} macro has to preserve the context on the stack, in
3569 order to have the \c{%$ifnot} referred to by the \c{if} macro be the
3570 same as the one defined by the \c{endif} macro, but has to change
3571 the context's name so that \c{endif} will know there was an
3572 intervening \c{else}. It does this by the use of \c{%repl}.
3574 A sample usage of these macros might look like:
3596 The block-\c{IF} macros handle nesting quite happily, by means of
3597 pushing another context, describing the inner \c{if}, on top of the
3598 one describing the outer \c{if}; thus \c{else} and \c{endif} always
3599 refer to the last unmatched \c{if} or \c{else}.
3602 \H{stackrel} \i{Stack Relative Preprocessor Directives}
3604 The following preprocessor directives provide a way to use
3605 labels to refer to local variables allocated on the stack.
3607 \b\c{%arg} (see \k{arg})
3609 \b\c{%stacksize} (see \k{stacksize})
3611 \b\c{%local} (see \k{local})
3614 \S{arg} \i\c{%arg} Directive
3616 The \c{%arg} directive is used to simplify the handling of
3617 parameters passed on the stack. Stack based parameter passing
3618 is used by many high level languages, including C, C++ and Pascal.
3620 While NASM has macros which attempt to duplicate this
3621 functionality (see \k{16cmacro}), the syntax is not particularly
3622 convenient to use and is not TASM compatible. Here is an example
3623 which shows the use of \c{%arg} without any external macros:
3627 \c %push mycontext ; save the current context
3628 \c %stacksize large ; tell NASM to use bp
3629 \c %arg i:word, j_ptr:word
3636 \c %pop ; restore original context
3638 This is similar to the procedure defined in \k{16cmacro} and adds
3639 the value in i to the value pointed to by j_ptr and returns the
3640 sum in the ax register. See \k{pushpop} for an explanation of
3641 \c{push} and \c{pop} and the use of context stacks.
3644 \S{stacksize} \i\c{%stacksize} Directive
3646 The \c{%stacksize} directive is used in conjunction with the
3647 \c{%arg} (see \k{arg}) and the \c{%local} (see \k{local}) directives.
3648 It tells NASM the default size to use for subsequent \c{%arg} and
3649 \c{%local} directives. The \c{%stacksize} directive takes one
3650 required argument which is one of \c{flat}, \c{flat64}, \c{large} or \c{small}.
3654 This form causes NASM to use stack-based parameter addressing
3655 relative to \c{ebp} and it assumes that a near form of call was used
3656 to get to this label (i.e. that \c{eip} is on the stack).
3658 \c %stacksize flat64
3660 This form causes NASM to use stack-based parameter addressing
3661 relative to \c{rbp} and it assumes that a near form of call was used
3662 to get to this label (i.e. that \c{rip} is on the stack).
3666 This form uses \c{bp} to do stack-based parameter addressing and
3667 assumes that a far form of call was used to get to this address
3668 (i.e. that \c{ip} and \c{cs} are on the stack).
3672 This form also uses \c{bp} to address stack parameters, but it is
3673 different from \c{large} because it also assumes that the old value
3674 of bp is pushed onto the stack (i.e. it expects an \c{ENTER}
3675 instruction). In other words, it expects that \c{bp}, \c{ip} and
3676 \c{cs} are on the top of the stack, underneath any local space which
3677 may have been allocated by \c{ENTER}. This form is probably most
3678 useful when used in combination with the \c{%local} directive
3682 \S{local} \i\c{%local} Directive
3684 The \c{%local} directive is used to simplify the use of local
3685 temporary stack variables allocated in a stack frame. Automatic
3686 local variables in C are an example of this kind of variable. The
3687 \c{%local} directive is most useful when used with the \c{%stacksize}
3688 (see \k{stacksize} and is also compatible with the \c{%arg} directive
3689 (see \k{arg}). It allows simplified reference to variables on the
3690 stack which have been allocated typically by using the \c{ENTER}
3692 \# (see \k{insENTER} for a description of that instruction).
3693 An example of its use is the following:
3697 \c %push mycontext ; save the current context
3698 \c %stacksize small ; tell NASM to use bp
3699 \c %assign %$localsize 0 ; see text for explanation
3700 \c %local old_ax:word, old_dx:word
3702 \c enter %$localsize,0 ; see text for explanation
3703 \c mov [old_ax],ax ; swap ax & bx
3704 \c mov [old_dx],dx ; and swap dx & cx
3709 \c leave ; restore old bp
3712 \c %pop ; restore original context
3714 The \c{%$localsize} variable is used internally by the
3715 \c{%local} directive and \e{must} be defined within the
3716 current context before the \c{%local} directive may be used.
3717 Failure to do so will result in one expression syntax error for
3718 each \c{%local} variable declared. It then may be used in
3719 the construction of an appropriately sized ENTER instruction
3720 as shown in the example.
3723 \H{pperror} Reporting \i{User-Defined Errors}: \i\c{%error}, \i\c{%warning}, \i\c{%fatal}
3725 The preprocessor directive \c{%error} will cause NASM to report an
3726 error if it occurs in assembled code. So if other users are going to
3727 try to assemble your source files, you can ensure that they define the
3728 right macros by means of code like this:
3733 \c ; do some different setup
3735 \c %error "Neither F1 nor F2 was defined."
3738 Then any user who fails to understand the way your code is supposed
3739 to be assembled will be quickly warned of their mistake, rather than
3740 having to wait until the program crashes on being run and then not
3741 knowing what went wrong.
3743 Similarly, \c{%warning} issues a warning, but allows assembly to continue:
3748 \c ; do some different setup
3750 \c %warning "Neither F1 nor F2 was defined, assuming F1."
3754 \c{%error} and \c{%warning} are issued only on the final assembly
3755 pass. This makes them safe to use in conjunction with tests that
3756 depend on symbol values.
3758 \c{%fatal} terminates assembly immediately, regardless of pass. This
3759 is useful when there is no point in continuing the assembly further,
3760 and doing so is likely just going to cause a spew of confusing error
3763 It is optional for the message string after \c{%error}, \c{%warning}
3764 or \c{%fatal} to be quoted. If it is \e{not}, then single-line macros
3765 are expanded in it, which can be used to display more information to
3766 the user. For example:
3769 \c %assign foo_over foo-64
3770 \c %error foo is foo_over bytes too large
3774 \H{otherpreproc} \i{Other Preprocessor Directives}
3776 NASM also has preprocessor directives which allow access to
3777 information from external sources. Currently they include:
3779 \b\c{%line} enables NASM to correctly handle the output of another
3780 preprocessor (see \k{line}).
3782 \b\c{%!} enables NASM to read in the value of an environment variable,
3783 which can then be used in your program (see \k{getenv}).
3785 \S{line} \i\c{%line} Directive
3787 The \c{%line} directive is used to notify NASM that the input line
3788 corresponds to a specific line number in another file. Typically
3789 this other file would be an original source file, with the current
3790 NASM input being the output of a pre-processor. The \c{%line}
3791 directive allows NASM to output messages which indicate the line
3792 number of the original source file, instead of the file that is being
3795 This preprocessor directive is not generally of use to programmers,
3796 by may be of interest to preprocessor authors. The usage of the
3797 \c{%line} preprocessor directive is as follows:
3799 \c %line nnn[+mmm] [filename]
3801 In this directive, \c{nnn} identifies the line of the original source
3802 file which this line corresponds to. \c{mmm} is an optional parameter
3803 which specifies a line increment value; each line of the input file
3804 read in is considered to correspond to \c{mmm} lines of the original
3805 source file. Finally, \c{filename} is an optional parameter which
3806 specifies the file name of the original source file.
3808 After reading a \c{%line} preprocessor directive, NASM will report
3809 all file name and line numbers relative to the values specified
3813 \S{getenv} \i\c{%!}\c{<env>}: Read an environment variable.
3815 The \c{%!<env>} directive makes it possible to read the value of an
3816 environment variable at assembly time. This could, for example, be used
3817 to store the contents of an environment variable into a string, which
3818 could be used at some other point in your code.
3820 For example, suppose that you have an environment variable \c{FOO}, and
3821 you want the contents of \c{FOO} to be embedded in your program. You
3822 could do that as follows:
3824 \c %defstr FOO %!FOO
3826 See \k{defstr} for notes on the \c{%defstr} directive.
3828 If the name of the environment variable contains non-identifier
3829 characters, you can use string quotes to surround the name of the
3830 variable, for example:
3832 \c %defstr C_colon %!'C:'
3835 \H{stdmac} \i{Standard Macros}
3837 NASM defines a set of standard macros, which are already defined
3838 when it starts to process any source file. If you really need a
3839 program to be assembled with no pre-defined macros, you can use the
3840 \i\c{%clear} directive to empty the preprocessor of everything but
3841 context-local preprocessor variables and single-line macros.
3843 Most \i{user-level assembler directives} (see \k{directive}) are
3844 implemented as macros which invoke primitive directives; these are
3845 described in \k{directive}. The rest of the standard macro set is
3849 \S{stdmacver} \i{NASM Version} Macros
3851 The single-line macros \i\c{__NASM_MAJOR__}, \i\c{__NASM_MINOR__},
3852 \i\c{__NASM_SUBMINOR__} and \i\c{___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__} expand to the
3853 major, minor, subminor and patch level parts of the \i{version
3854 number of NASM} being used. So, under NASM 0.98.32p1 for
3855 example, \c{__NASM_MAJOR__} would be defined to be 0, \c{__NASM_MINOR__}
3856 would be defined as 98, \c{__NASM_SUBMINOR__} would be defined to 32,
3857 and \c{___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__} would be defined as 1.
3859 Additionally, the macro \i\c{__NASM_SNAPSHOT__} is defined for
3860 automatically generated snapshot releases \e{only}.
3863 \S{stdmacverid} \i\c{__NASM_VERSION_ID__}: \i{NASM Version ID}
3865 The single-line macro \c{__NASM_VERSION_ID__} expands to a dword integer
3866 representing the full version number of the version of nasm being used.
3867 The value is the equivalent to \c{__NASM_MAJOR__}, \c{__NASM_MINOR__},
3868 \c{__NASM_SUBMINOR__} and \c{___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__} concatenated to
3869 produce a single doubleword. Hence, for 0.98.32p1, the returned number
3870 would be equivalent to:
3878 Note that the above lines are generate exactly the same code, the second
3879 line is used just to give an indication of the order that the separate
3880 values will be present in memory.
3883 \S{stdmacverstr} \i\c{__NASM_VER__}: \i{NASM Version string}
3885 The single-line macro \c{__NASM_VER__} expands to a string which defines
3886 the version number of nasm being used. So, under NASM 0.98.32 for example,
3895 \S{fileline} \i\c{__FILE__} and \i\c{__LINE__}: File Name and Line Number
3897 Like the C preprocessor, NASM allows the user to find out the file
3898 name and line number containing the current instruction. The macro
3899 \c{__FILE__} expands to a string constant giving the name of the
3900 current input file (which may change through the course of assembly
3901 if \c{%include} directives are used), and \c{__LINE__} expands to a
3902 numeric constant giving the current line number in the input file.
3904 These macros could be used, for example, to communicate debugging
3905 information to a macro, since invoking \c{__LINE__} inside a macro
3906 definition (either single-line or multi-line) will return the line
3907 number of the macro \e{call}, rather than \e{definition}. So to
3908 determine where in a piece of code a crash is occurring, for
3909 example, one could write a routine \c{stillhere}, which is passed a
3910 line number in \c{EAX} and outputs something like `line 155: still
3911 here'. You could then write a macro
3913 \c %macro notdeadyet 0
3922 and then pepper your code with calls to \c{notdeadyet} until you
3923 find the crash point.
3926 \S{bitsm} \i\c{__BITS__}: Current BITS Mode
3928 The \c{__BITS__} standard macro is updated every time that the BITS mode is
3929 set using the \c{BITS XX} or \c{[BITS XX]} directive, where XX is a valid mode
3930 number of 16, 32 or 64. \c{__BITS__} receives the specified mode number and
3931 makes it globally available. This can be very useful for those who utilize
3932 mode-dependent macros.
3934 \S{ofmtm} \i\c{__OUTPUT_FORMAT__}: Current Output Format
3936 The \c{__OUTPUT_FORMAT__} standard macro holds the current Output Format,
3937 as given by the \c{-f} option or NASM's default. Type \c{nasm -hf} for a
3940 \c %ifidn __OUTPUT_FORMAT__, win32
3941 \c %define NEWLINE 13, 10
3942 \c %elifidn __OUTPUT_FORMAT__, elf32
3943 \c %define NEWLINE 10
3947 \S{datetime} Assembly Date and Time Macros
3949 NASM provides a variety of macros that represent the timestamp of the
3952 \b The \i\c{__DATE__} and \i\c{__TIME__} macros give the assembly date and
3953 time as strings, in ISO 8601 format (\c{"YYYY-MM-DD"} and \c{"HH:MM:SS"},
3956 \b The \i\c{__DATE_NUM__} and \i\c{__TIME_NUM__} macros give the assembly
3957 date and time in numeric form; in the format \c{YYYYMMDD} and
3958 \c{HHMMSS} respectively.
3960 \b The \i\c{__UTC_DATE__} and \i\c{__UTC_TIME__} macros give the assembly
3961 date and time in universal time (UTC) as strings, in ISO 8601 format
3962 (\c{"YYYY-MM-DD"} and \c{"HH:MM:SS"}, respectively.) If the host
3963 platform doesn't provide UTC time, these macros are undefined.
3965 \b The \i\c{__UTC_DATE_NUM__} and \i\c{__UTC_TIME_NUM__} macros give the
3966 assembly date and time universal time (UTC) in numeric form; in the
3967 format \c{YYYYMMDD} and \c{HHMMSS} respectively. If the
3968 host platform doesn't provide UTC time, these macros are
3971 \b The \c{__POSIX_TIME__} macro is defined as a number containing the
3972 number of seconds since the POSIX epoch, 1 January 1970 00:00:00 UTC;
3973 excluding any leap seconds. This is computed using UTC time if
3974 available on the host platform, otherwise it is computed using the
3975 local time as if it was UTC.
3977 All instances of time and date macros in the same assembly session
3978 produce consistent output. For example, in an assembly session
3979 started at 42 seconds after midnight on January 1, 2010 in Moscow
3980 (timezone UTC+3) these macros would have the following values,
3981 assuming, of course, a properly configured environment with a correct
3984 \c __DATE__ "2010-01-01"
3985 \c __TIME__ "00:00:42"
3986 \c __DATE_NUM__ 20100101
3987 \c __TIME_NUM__ 000042
3988 \c __UTC_DATE__ "2009-12-31"
3989 \c __UTC_TIME__ "21:00:42"
3990 \c __UTC_DATE_NUM__ 20091231
3991 \c __UTC_TIME_NUM__ 210042
3992 \c __POSIX_TIME__ 1262293242
3995 \S{use_def} \I\c{__USE_*__}\c{__USE_}\e{package}\c{__}: Package
3998 When a standard macro package (see \k{macropkg}) is included with the
3999 \c{%use} directive (see \k{use}), a single-line macro of the form
4000 \c{__USE_}\e{package}\c{__} is automatically defined. This allows
4001 testing if a particular package is invoked or not.
4003 For example, if the \c{altreg} package is included (see
4004 \k{pkg_altreg}), then the macro \c{__USE_ALTREG__} is defined.
4007 \S{pass_macro} \i\c{__PASS__}: Assembly Pass
4009 The macro \c{__PASS__} is defined to be \c{1} on preparatory passes,
4010 and \c{2} on the final pass. In preprocess-only mode, it is set to
4011 \c{3}, and when running only to generate dependencies (due to the
4012 \c{-M} or \c{-MG} option, see \k{opt-M}) it is set to \c{0}.
4014 \e{Avoid using this macro if at all possible. It is tremendously easy
4015 to generate very strange errors by misusing it, and the semantics may
4016 change in future versions of NASM.}
4019 \S{struc} \i\c{STRUC} and \i\c{ENDSTRUC}: \i{Declaring Structure} Data Types
4021 The core of NASM contains no intrinsic means of defining data
4022 structures; instead, the preprocessor is sufficiently powerful that
4023 data structures can be implemented as a set of macros. The macros
4024 \c{STRUC} and \c{ENDSTRUC} are used to define a structure data type.
4026 \c{STRUC} takes one or two parameters. The first parameter is the name
4027 of the data type. The second, optional parameter is the base offset of
4028 the structure. The name of the data type is defined as a symbol with
4029 the value of the base offset, and the name of the data type with the
4030 suffix \c{_size} appended to it is defined as an \c{EQU} giving the
4031 size of the structure. Once \c{STRUC} has been issued, you are
4032 defining the structure, and should define fields using the \c{RESB}
4033 family of pseudo-instructions, and then invoke \c{ENDSTRUC} to finish
4036 For example, to define a structure called \c{mytype} containing a
4037 longword, a word, a byte and a string of bytes, you might code
4048 The above code defines six symbols: \c{mt_long} as 0 (the offset
4049 from the beginning of a \c{mytype} structure to the longword field),
4050 \c{mt_word} as 4, \c{mt_byte} as 6, \c{mt_str} as 7, \c{mytype_size}
4051 as 39, and \c{mytype} itself as zero.
4053 The reason why the structure type name is defined at zero by default
4054 is a side effect of allowing structures to work with the local label
4055 mechanism: if your structure members tend to have the same names in
4056 more than one structure, you can define the above structure like this:
4067 This defines the offsets to the structure fields as \c{mytype.long},
4068 \c{mytype.word}, \c{mytype.byte} and \c{mytype.str}.
4070 NASM, since it has no \e{intrinsic} structure support, does not
4071 support any form of period notation to refer to the elements of a
4072 structure once you have one (except the above local-label notation),
4073 so code such as \c{mov ax,[mystruc.mt_word]} is not valid.
4074 \c{mt_word} is a constant just like any other constant, so the
4075 correct syntax is \c{mov ax,[mystruc+mt_word]} or \c{mov
4076 ax,[mystruc+mytype.word]}.
4078 Sometimes you only have the address of the structure displaced by an
4079 offset. For example, consider this standard stack frame setup:
4085 In this case, you could access an element by subtracting the offset:
4087 \c mov [ebp - 40 + mytype.word], ax
4089 However, if you do not want to repeat this offset, you can use -40 as
4092 \c struc mytype, -40
4094 And access an element this way:
4096 \c mov [ebp + mytype.word], ax
4099 \S{istruc} \i\c{ISTRUC}, \i\c{AT} and \i\c{IEND}: Declaring
4100 \i{Instances of Structures}
4102 Having defined a structure type, the next thing you typically want
4103 to do is to declare instances of that structure in your data
4104 segment. NASM provides an easy way to do this in the \c{ISTRUC}
4105 mechanism. To declare a structure of type \c{mytype} in a program,
4106 you code something like this:
4111 \c at mt_long, dd 123456
4112 \c at mt_word, dw 1024
4113 \c at mt_byte, db 'x'
4114 \c at mt_str, db 'hello, world', 13, 10, 0
4118 The function of the \c{AT} macro is to make use of the \c{TIMES}
4119 prefix to advance the assembly position to the correct point for the
4120 specified structure field, and then to declare the specified data.
4121 Therefore the structure fields must be declared in the same order as
4122 they were specified in the structure definition.
4124 If the data to go in a structure field requires more than one source
4125 line to specify, the remaining source lines can easily come after
4126 the \c{AT} line. For example:
4128 \c at mt_str, db 123,134,145,156,167,178,189
4131 Depending on personal taste, you can also omit the code part of the
4132 \c{AT} line completely, and start the structure field on the next
4136 \c db 'hello, world'
4140 \S{align} \i\c{ALIGN} and \i\c{ALIGNB}: Data Alignment
4142 The \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB} macros provides a convenient way to
4143 align code or data on a word, longword, paragraph or other boundary.
4144 (Some assemblers call this directive \i\c{EVEN}.) The syntax of the
4145 \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB} macros is
4147 \c align 4 ; align on 4-byte boundary
4148 \c align 16 ; align on 16-byte boundary
4149 \c align 8,db 0 ; pad with 0s rather than NOPs
4150 \c align 4,resb 1 ; align to 4 in the BSS
4151 \c alignb 4 ; equivalent to previous line
4153 Both macros require their first argument to be a power of two; they
4154 both compute the number of additional bytes required to bring the
4155 length of the current section up to a multiple of that power of two,
4156 and then apply the \c{TIMES} prefix to their second argument to
4157 perform the alignment.
4159 If the second argument is not specified, the default for \c{ALIGN}
4160 is \c{NOP}, and the default for \c{ALIGNB} is \c{RESB 1}. So if the
4161 second argument is specified, the two macros are equivalent.
4162 Normally, you can just use \c{ALIGN} in code and data sections and
4163 \c{ALIGNB} in BSS sections, and never need the second argument
4164 except for special purposes.
4166 \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB}, being simple macros, perform no error
4167 checking: they cannot warn you if their first argument fails to be a
4168 power of two, or if their second argument generates more than one
4169 byte of code. In each of these cases they will silently do the wrong
4172 \c{ALIGNB} (or \c{ALIGN} with a second argument of \c{RESB 1}) can
4173 be used within structure definitions:
4190 This will ensure that the structure members are sensibly aligned
4191 relative to the base of the structure.
4193 A final caveat: \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB} work relative to the
4194 beginning of the \e{section}, not the beginning of the address space
4195 in the final executable. Aligning to a 16-byte boundary when the
4196 section you're in is only guaranteed to be aligned to a 4-byte
4197 boundary, for example, is a waste of effort. Again, NASM does not
4198 check that the section's alignment characteristics are sensible for
4199 the use of \c{ALIGN} or \c{ALIGNB}.
4201 Both \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB} do call \c{SECTALIGN} macro implicitly.
4202 See \k{sectalign} for details.
4204 See also the \c{smartalign} standard macro package, \k{pkg_smartalign}.
4207 \S{sectalign} \i\c{SECTALIGN}: Section Alignment
4209 The \c{SECTALIGN} macros provides a way to modify alignment attribute
4210 of output file section. Unlike the \c{align=} attribute (which is allowed
4211 at section definition only) the \c{SECTALIGN} macro may be used at any time.
4213 For example the directive
4217 sets the section alignment requirements to 16 bytes. Once increased it can
4218 not be decreased, the magnitude may grow only.
4220 Note that \c{ALIGN} (see \k{align}) calls the \c{SECTALIGN} macro implicitly
4221 so the active section alignment requirements may be updated. This is by default
4222 behaviour, if for some reason you want the \c{ALIGN} do not call \c{SECTALIGN}
4223 at all use the directive
4227 It is still possible to turn in on again by
4232 \C{macropkg} \i{Standard Macro Packages}
4234 The \i\c{%use} directive (see \k{use}) includes one of the standard
4235 macro packages included with the NASM distribution and compiled into
4236 the NASM binary. It operates like the \c{%include} directive (see
4237 \k{include}), but the included contents is provided by NASM itself.
4239 The names of standard macro packages are case insensitive, and can be
4243 \H{pkg_altreg} \i\c{altreg}: \i{Alternate Register Names}
4245 The \c{altreg} standard macro package provides alternate register
4246 names. It provides numeric register names for all registers (not just
4247 \c{R8}-\c{R15}), the Intel-defined aliases \c{R8L}-\c{R15L} for the
4248 low bytes of register (as opposed to the NASM/AMD standard names
4249 \c{R8B}-\c{R15B}), and the names \c{R0H}-\c{R3H} (by analogy with
4250 \c{R0L}-\c{R3L}) for \c{AH}, \c{CH}, \c{DH}, and \c{BH}.
4257 \c mov r0l,r3h ; mov al,bh
4263 \H{pkg_smartalign} \i\c{smartalign}\I{align, smart}: Smart \c{ALIGN} Macro
4265 The \c{smartalign} standard macro package provides for an \i\c{ALIGN}
4266 macro which is more powerful than the default (and
4267 backwards-compatible) one (see \k{align}). When the \c{smartalign}
4268 package is enabled, when \c{ALIGN} is used without a second argument,
4269 NASM will generate a sequence of instructions more efficient than a
4270 series of \c{NOP}. Furthermore, if the padding exceeds a specific
4271 threshold, then NASM will generate a jump over the entire padding
4274 The specific instructions generated can be controlled with the
4275 new \i\c{ALIGNMODE} macro. This macro takes two parameters: one mode,
4276 and an optional jump threshold override. If (for any reason) you need
4277 to turn off the jump completely just set jump threshold value to -1
4278 (or set it to \c{nojmp}). The following modes are possible:
4280 \b \c{generic}: Works on all x86 CPUs and should have reasonable
4281 performance. The default jump threshold is 8. This is the
4284 \b \c{nop}: Pad out with \c{NOP} instructions. The only difference
4285 compared to the standard \c{ALIGN} macro is that NASM can still jump
4286 over a large padding area. The default jump threshold is 16.
4288 \b \c{k7}: Optimize for the AMD K7 (Athlon/Althon XP). These
4289 instructions should still work on all x86 CPUs. The default jump
4292 \b \c{k8}: Optimize for the AMD K8 (Opteron/Althon 64). These
4293 instructions should still work on all x86 CPUs. The default jump
4296 \b \c{p6}: Optimize for Intel CPUs. This uses the long \c{NOP}
4297 instructions first introduced in Pentium Pro. This is incompatible
4298 with all CPUs of family 5 or lower, as well as some VIA CPUs and
4299 several virtualization solutions. The default jump threshold is 16.
4301 The macro \i\c{__ALIGNMODE__} is defined to contain the current
4302 alignment mode. A number of other macros beginning with \c{__ALIGN_}
4303 are used internally by this macro package.
4306 \H{pkg_fp} \i\c\{fp}: Floating-point macros
4308 This packages contains the following floating-point convenience macros:
4310 \c %define Inf __Infinity__
4311 \c %define NaN __QNaN__
4312 \c %define QNaN __QNaN__
4313 \c %define SNaN __SNaN__
4315 \c %define float8(x) __float8__(x)
4316 \c %define float16(x) __float16__(x)
4317 \c %define float32(x) __float32__(x)
4318 \c %define float64(x) __float64__(x)
4319 \c %define float80m(x) __float80m__(x)
4320 \c %define float80e(x) __float80e__(x)
4321 \c %define float128l(x) __float128l__(x)
4322 \c %define float128h(x) __float128h__(x)
4325 \H{pkg_ifunc} \i\c{ifunc}: \i{Integer functions}
4327 This package contains a set of macros which implement integer
4328 functions. These are actually implemented as special operators, but
4329 are most conveniently accessed via this macro package.
4331 The macros provided are:
4333 \S{ilog2} \i{Integer logarithms}
4335 These functions calculate the integer logarithm base 2 of their
4336 argument, considered as an unsigned integer. The only differences
4337 between the functions is their behavior if the argument provided is
4340 The function \i\c{ilog2e()} (alias \i\c{ilog2()}) generate an error if
4341 the argument is not a power of two.
4343 The function \i\c{ilog2w()} generate a warning if the argument is not
4346 The function \i\c{ilog2f()} rounds the argument down to the nearest
4347 power of two; if the argument is zero it returns zero.
4349 The function \i\c{ilog2c()} rounds the argument up to the nearest
4353 \C{directive} \i{Assembler Directives}
4355 NASM, though it attempts to avoid the bureaucracy of assemblers like
4356 MASM and TASM, is nevertheless forced to support a \e{few}
4357 directives. These are described in this chapter.
4359 NASM's directives come in two types: \I{user-level
4360 directives}\e{user-level} directives and \I{primitive
4361 directives}\e{primitive} directives. Typically, each directive has a
4362 user-level form and a primitive form. In almost all cases, we
4363 recommend that users use the user-level forms of the directives,
4364 which are implemented as macros which call the primitive forms.
4366 Primitive directives are enclosed in square brackets; user-level
4369 In addition to the universal directives described in this chapter,
4370 each object file format can optionally supply extra directives in
4371 order to control particular features of that file format. These
4372 \I{format-specific directives}\e{format-specific} directives are
4373 documented along with the formats that implement them, in \k{outfmt}.
4376 \H{bits} \i\c{BITS}: Specifying Target \i{Processor Mode}
4378 The \c{BITS} directive specifies whether NASM should generate code
4379 \I{16-bit mode, versus 32-bit mode}designed to run on a processor
4380 operating in 16-bit mode, 32-bit mode or 64-bit mode. The syntax is
4381 \c{BITS XX}, where XX is 16, 32 or 64.
4383 In most cases, you should not need to use \c{BITS} explicitly. The
4384 \c{aout}, \c{coff}, \c{elf}, \c{macho}, \c{win32} and \c{win64}
4385 object formats, which are designed for use in 32-bit or 64-bit
4386 operating systems, all cause NASM to select 32-bit or 64-bit mode,
4387 respectively, by default. The \c{obj} object format allows you
4388 to specify each segment you define as either \c{USE16} or \c{USE32},
4389 and NASM will set its operating mode accordingly, so the use of the
4390 \c{BITS} directive is once again unnecessary.
4392 The most likely reason for using the \c{BITS} directive is to write
4393 32-bit or 64-bit code in a flat binary file; this is because the \c{bin}
4394 output format defaults to 16-bit mode in anticipation of it being
4395 used most frequently to write DOS \c{.COM} programs, DOS \c{.SYS}
4396 device drivers and boot loader software.
4398 The \c{BITS} directive can also be used to generate code for a
4399 different mode than the standard one for the output format.
4401 You do \e{not} need to specify \c{BITS 32} merely in order to use
4402 32-bit instructions in a 16-bit DOS program; if you do, the
4403 assembler will generate incorrect code because it will be writing
4404 code targeted at a 32-bit platform, to be run on a 16-bit one.
4406 When NASM is in \c{BITS 16} mode, instructions which use 32-bit
4407 data are prefixed with an 0x66 byte, and those referring to 32-bit
4408 addresses have an 0x67 prefix. In \c{BITS 32} mode, the reverse is
4409 true: 32-bit instructions require no prefixes, whereas instructions
4410 using 16-bit data need an 0x66 and those working on 16-bit addresses
4413 When NASM is in \c{BITS 64} mode, most instructions operate the same
4414 as they do for \c{BITS 32} mode. However, there are 8 more general and
4415 SSE registers, and 16-bit addressing is no longer supported.
4417 The default address size is 64 bits; 32-bit addressing can be selected
4418 with the 0x67 prefix. The default operand size is still 32 bits,
4419 however, and the 0x66 prefix selects 16-bit operand size. The \c{REX}
4420 prefix is used both to select 64-bit operand size, and to access the
4421 new registers. NASM automatically inserts REX prefixes when
4424 When the \c{REX} prefix is used, the processor does not know how to
4425 address the AH, BH, CH or DH (high 8-bit legacy) registers. Instead,
4426 it is possible to access the the low 8-bits of the SP, BP SI and DI
4427 registers as SPL, BPL, SIL and DIL, respectively; but only when the
4430 The \c{BITS} directive has an exactly equivalent primitive form,
4431 \c{[BITS 16]}, \c{[BITS 32]} and \c{[BITS 64]}. The user-level form is
4432 a macro which has no function other than to call the primitive form.
4434 Note that the space is neccessary, e.g. \c{BITS32} will \e{not} work!
4436 \S{USE16 & USE32} \i\c{USE16} & \i\c{USE32}: Aliases for BITS
4438 The `\c{USE16}' and `\c{USE32}' directives can be used in place of
4439 `\c{BITS 16}' and `\c{BITS 32}', for compatibility with other assemblers.
4442 \H{default} \i\c{DEFAULT}: Change the assembler defaults
4444 The \c{DEFAULT} directive changes the assembler defaults. Normally,
4445 NASM defaults to a mode where the programmer is expected to explicitly
4446 specify most features directly. However, this is occasionally
4447 obnoxious, as the explicit form is pretty much the only one one wishes
4450 Currently, \c{DEFAULT} can set \c{REL} & \c{ABS} and \c{BND} & \c{NOBND}.
4452 \S{REL & ABS} \i\c{REL} & \i\c{ABS}: RIP-relative addressing
4454 This sets whether registerless instructions in 64-bit mode are \c{RIP}-relative
4455 or not. By default, they are absolute unless overridden with the \i\c{REL}
4456 specifier (see \k{effaddr}). However, if \c{DEFAULT REL} is
4457 specified, \c{REL} is default, unless overridden with the \c{ABS}
4458 specifier, \e{except when used with an FS or GS segment override}.
4460 The special handling of \c{FS} and \c{GS} overrides are due to the
4461 fact that these registers are generally used as thread pointers or
4462 other special functions in 64-bit mode, and generating
4463 \c{RIP}-relative addresses would be extremely confusing.
4465 \c{DEFAULT REL} is disabled with \c{DEFAULT ABS}.
4467 \S{BND & NOBND} \i\c{BND} & \i\c{NOBND}: \c{BND} prefix
4469 If \c{DEFAULT BND} is set, all bnd-prefix available instructions following
4470 this directive are prefixed with bnd. To override it, \c{NOBND} prefix can
4474 \c call foo ; BND will be prefixed
4475 \c nobnd call foo ; BND will NOT be prefixed
4477 \c{DEFAULT NOBND} can disable \c{DEFAULT BND} and then \c{BND} prefix will be
4478 added only when explicitly specified in code.
4480 \c{DEFAULT BND} is expected to be the normal configuration for writing
4483 \H{section} \i\c{SECTION} or \i\c{SEGMENT}: Changing and \i{Defining
4486 \I{changing sections}\I{switching between sections}The \c{SECTION}
4487 directive (\c{SEGMENT} is an exactly equivalent synonym) changes
4488 which section of the output file the code you write will be
4489 assembled into. In some object file formats, the number and names of
4490 sections are fixed; in others, the user may make up as many as they
4491 wish. Hence \c{SECTION} may sometimes give an error message, or may
4492 define a new section, if you try to switch to a section that does
4495 The Unix object formats, and the \c{bin} object format (but see
4496 \k{multisec}), all support
4497 the \i{standardized section names} \c{.text}, \c{.data} and \c{.bss}
4498 for the code, data and uninitialized-data sections. The \c{obj}
4499 format, by contrast, does not recognize these section names as being
4500 special, and indeed will strip off the leading period of any section
4504 \S{sectmac} The \i\c{__SECT__} Macro
4506 The \c{SECTION} directive is unusual in that its user-level form
4507 functions differently from its primitive form. The primitive form,
4508 \c{[SECTION xyz]}, simply switches the current target section to the
4509 one given. The user-level form, \c{SECTION xyz}, however, first
4510 defines the single-line macro \c{__SECT__} to be the primitive
4511 \c{[SECTION]} directive which it is about to issue, and then issues
4512 it. So the user-level directive
4516 expands to the two lines
4518 \c %define __SECT__ [SECTION .text]
4521 Users may find it useful to make use of this in their own macros.
4522 For example, the \c{writefile} macro defined in \k{mlmacgre} can be
4523 usefully rewritten in the following more sophisticated form:
4525 \c %macro writefile 2+
4535 \c mov cx,%%endstr-%%str
4542 This form of the macro, once passed a string to output, first
4543 switches temporarily to the data section of the file, using the
4544 primitive form of the \c{SECTION} directive so as not to modify
4545 \c{__SECT__}. It then declares its string in the data section, and
4546 then invokes \c{__SECT__} to switch back to \e{whichever} section
4547 the user was previously working in. It thus avoids the need, in the
4548 previous version of the macro, to include a \c{JMP} instruction to
4549 jump over the data, and also does not fail if, in a complicated
4550 \c{OBJ} format module, the user could potentially be assembling the
4551 code in any of several separate code sections.
4554 \H{absolute} \i\c{ABSOLUTE}: Defining Absolute Labels
4556 The \c{ABSOLUTE} directive can be thought of as an alternative form
4557 of \c{SECTION}: it causes the subsequent code to be directed at no
4558 physical section, but at the hypothetical section starting at the
4559 given absolute address. The only instructions you can use in this
4560 mode are the \c{RESB} family.
4562 \c{ABSOLUTE} is used as follows:
4570 This example describes a section of the PC BIOS data area, at
4571 segment address 0x40: the above code defines \c{kbuf_chr} to be
4572 0x1A, \c{kbuf_free} to be 0x1C, and \c{kbuf} to be 0x1E.
4574 The user-level form of \c{ABSOLUTE}, like that of \c{SECTION},
4575 redefines the \i\c{__SECT__} macro when it is invoked.
4577 \i\c{STRUC} and \i\c{ENDSTRUC} are defined as macros which use
4578 \c{ABSOLUTE} (and also \c{__SECT__}).
4580 \c{ABSOLUTE} doesn't have to take an absolute constant as an
4581 argument: it can take an expression (actually, a \i{critical
4582 expression}: see \k{crit}) and it can be a value in a segment. For
4583 example, a TSR can re-use its setup code as run-time BSS like this:
4585 \c org 100h ; it's a .COM program
4587 \c jmp setup ; setup code comes last
4589 \c ; the resident part of the TSR goes here
4591 \c ; now write the code that installs the TSR here
4595 \c runtimevar1 resw 1
4596 \c runtimevar2 resd 20
4600 This defines some variables `on top of' the setup code, so that
4601 after the setup has finished running, the space it took up can be
4602 re-used as data storage for the running TSR. The symbol `tsr_end'
4603 can be used to calculate the total size of the part of the TSR that
4604 needs to be made resident.
4607 \H{extern} \i\c{EXTERN}: \i{Importing Symbols} from Other Modules
4609 \c{EXTERN} is similar to the MASM directive \c{EXTRN} and the C
4610 keyword \c{extern}: it is used to declare a symbol which is not
4611 defined anywhere in the module being assembled, but is assumed to be
4612 defined in some other module and needs to be referred to by this
4613 one. Not every object-file format can support external variables:
4614 the \c{bin} format cannot.
4616 The \c{EXTERN} directive takes as many arguments as you like. Each
4617 argument is the name of a symbol:
4620 \c extern _sscanf,_fscanf
4622 Some object-file formats provide extra features to the \c{EXTERN}
4623 directive. In all cases, the extra features are used by suffixing a
4624 colon to the symbol name followed by object-format specific text.
4625 For example, the \c{obj} format allows you to declare that the
4626 default segment base of an external should be the group \c{dgroup}
4627 by means of the directive
4629 \c extern _variable:wrt dgroup
4631 The primitive form of \c{EXTERN} differs from the user-level form
4632 only in that it can take only one argument at a time: the support
4633 for multiple arguments is implemented at the preprocessor level.
4635 You can declare the same variable as \c{EXTERN} more than once: NASM
4636 will quietly ignore the second and later redeclarations. You can't
4637 declare a variable as \c{EXTERN} as well as something else, though.
4640 \H{global} \i\c{GLOBAL}: \i{Exporting Symbols} to Other Modules
4642 \c{GLOBAL} is the other end of \c{EXTERN}: if one module declares a
4643 symbol as \c{EXTERN} and refers to it, then in order to prevent
4644 linker errors, some other module must actually \e{define} the
4645 symbol and declare it as \c{GLOBAL}. Some assemblers use the name
4646 \i\c{PUBLIC} for this purpose.
4648 The \c{GLOBAL} directive applying to a symbol must appear \e{before}
4649 the definition of the symbol.
4651 \c{GLOBAL} uses the same syntax as \c{EXTERN}, except that it must
4652 refer to symbols which \e{are} defined in the same module as the
4653 \c{GLOBAL} directive. For example:
4659 \c{GLOBAL}, like \c{EXTERN}, allows object formats to define private
4660 extensions by means of a colon. The \c{elf} object format, for
4661 example, lets you specify whether global data items are functions or
4664 \c global hashlookup:function, hashtable:data
4666 Like \c{EXTERN}, the primitive form of \c{GLOBAL} differs from the
4667 user-level form only in that it can take only one argument at a
4671 \H{common} \i\c{COMMON}: Defining Common Data Areas
4673 The \c{COMMON} directive is used to declare \i\e{common variables}.
4674 A common variable is much like a global variable declared in the
4675 uninitialized data section, so that
4679 is similar in function to
4686 The difference is that if more than one module defines the same
4687 common variable, then at link time those variables will be
4688 \e{merged}, and references to \c{intvar} in all modules will point
4689 at the same piece of memory.
4691 Like \c{GLOBAL} and \c{EXTERN}, \c{COMMON} supports object-format
4692 specific extensions. For example, the \c{obj} format allows common
4693 variables to be NEAR or FAR, and the \c{elf} format allows you to
4694 specify the alignment requirements of a common variable:
4696 \c common commvar 4:near ; works in OBJ
4697 \c common intarray 100:4 ; works in ELF: 4 byte aligned
4699 Once again, like \c{EXTERN} and \c{GLOBAL}, the primitive form of
4700 \c{COMMON} differs from the user-level form only in that it can take
4701 only one argument at a time.
4704 \H{CPU} \i\c{CPU}: Defining CPU Dependencies
4706 The \i\c{CPU} directive restricts assembly to those instructions which
4707 are available on the specified CPU.
4711 \b\c{CPU 8086} Assemble only 8086 instruction set
4713 \b\c{CPU 186} Assemble instructions up to the 80186 instruction set
4715 \b\c{CPU 286} Assemble instructions up to the 286 instruction set
4717 \b\c{CPU 386} Assemble instructions up to the 386 instruction set
4719 \b\c{CPU 486} 486 instruction set
4721 \b\c{CPU 586} Pentium instruction set
4723 \b\c{CPU PENTIUM} Same as 586
4725 \b\c{CPU 686} P6 instruction set
4727 \b\c{CPU PPRO} Same as 686
4729 \b\c{CPU P2} Same as 686
4731 \b\c{CPU P3} Pentium III (Katmai) instruction sets
4733 \b\c{CPU KATMAI} Same as P3
4735 \b\c{CPU P4} Pentium 4 (Willamette) instruction set
4737 \b\c{CPU WILLAMETTE} Same as P4
4739 \b\c{CPU PRESCOTT} Prescott instruction set
4741 \b\c{CPU X64} x86-64 (x64/AMD64/Intel 64) instruction set
4743 \b\c{CPU IA64} IA64 CPU (in x86 mode) instruction set
4745 All options are case insensitive. All instructions will be selected
4746 only if they apply to the selected CPU or lower. By default, all
4747 instructions are available.
4750 \H{FLOAT} \i\c{FLOAT}: Handling of \I{floating-point, constants}floating-point constants
4752 By default, floating-point constants are rounded to nearest, and IEEE
4753 denormals are supported. The following options can be set to alter
4756 \b\c{FLOAT DAZ} Flush denormals to zero
4758 \b\c{FLOAT NODAZ} Do not flush denormals to zero (default)
4760 \b\c{FLOAT NEAR} Round to nearest (default)
4762 \b\c{FLOAT UP} Round up (toward +Infinity)
4764 \b\c{FLOAT DOWN} Round down (toward -Infinity)
4766 \b\c{FLOAT ZERO} Round toward zero
4768 \b\c{FLOAT DEFAULT} Restore default settings
4770 The standard macros \i\c{__FLOAT_DAZ__}, \i\c{__FLOAT_ROUND__}, and
4771 \i\c{__FLOAT__} contain the current state, as long as the programmer
4772 has avoided the use of the brackeded primitive form, (\c{[FLOAT]}).
4774 \c{__FLOAT__} contains the full set of floating-point settings; this
4775 value can be saved away and invoked later to restore the setting.
4778 \C{outfmt} \i{Output Formats}
4780 NASM is a portable assembler, designed to be able to compile on any
4781 ANSI C-supporting platform and produce output to run on a variety of
4782 Intel x86 operating systems. For this reason, it has a large number
4783 of available output formats, selected using the \i\c{-f} option on
4784 the NASM \i{command line}. Each of these formats, along with its
4785 extensions to the base NASM syntax, is detailed in this chapter.
4787 As stated in \k{opt-o}, NASM chooses a \i{default name} for your
4788 output file based on the input file name and the chosen output
4789 format. This will be generated by removing the \i{extension}
4790 (\c{.asm}, \c{.s}, or whatever you like to use) from the input file
4791 name, and substituting an extension defined by the output format.
4792 The extensions are given with each format below.
4795 \H{binfmt} \i\c{bin}: \i{Flat-Form Binary}\I{pure binary} Output
4797 The \c{bin} format does not produce object files: it generates
4798 nothing in the output file except the code you wrote. Such `pure
4799 binary' files are used by \i{MS-DOS}: \i\c{.COM} executables and
4800 \i\c{.SYS} device drivers are pure binary files. Pure binary output
4801 is also useful for \i{operating system} and \i{boot loader}
4804 The \c{bin} format supports \i{multiple section names}. For details of
4805 how NASM handles sections in the \c{bin} format, see \k{multisec}.
4807 Using the \c{bin} format puts NASM by default into 16-bit mode (see
4808 \k{bits}). In order to use \c{bin} to write 32-bit or 64-bit code,
4809 such as an OS kernel, you need to explicitly issue the \I\c{BITS}\c{BITS 32}
4810 or \I\c{BITS}\c{BITS 64} directive.
4812 \c{bin} has no default output file name extension: instead, it
4813 leaves your file name as it is once the original extension has been
4814 removed. Thus, the default is for NASM to assemble \c{binprog.asm}
4815 into a binary file called \c{binprog}.
4818 \S{org} \i\c{ORG}: Binary File \i{Program Origin}
4820 The \c{bin} format provides an additional directive to the list
4821 given in \k{directive}: \c{ORG}. The function of the \c{ORG}
4822 directive is to specify the origin address which NASM will assume
4823 the program begins at when it is loaded into memory.
4825 For example, the following code will generate the longword
4832 Unlike the \c{ORG} directive provided by MASM-compatible assemblers,
4833 which allows you to jump around in the object file and overwrite
4834 code you have already generated, NASM's \c{ORG} does exactly what
4835 the directive says: \e{origin}. Its sole function is to specify one
4836 offset which is added to all internal address references within the
4837 section; it does not permit any of the trickery that MASM's version
4838 does. See \k{proborg} for further comments.
4841 \S{binseg} \c{bin} Extensions to the \c{SECTION}
4842 Directive\I{SECTION, bin extensions to}
4844 The \c{bin} output format extends the \c{SECTION} (or \c{SEGMENT})
4845 directive to allow you to specify the alignment requirements of
4846 segments. This is done by appending the \i\c{ALIGN} qualifier to the
4847 end of the section-definition line. For example,
4849 \c section .data align=16
4851 switches to the section \c{.data} and also specifies that it must be
4852 aligned on a 16-byte boundary.
4854 The parameter to \c{ALIGN} specifies how many low bits of the
4855 section start address must be forced to zero. The alignment value
4856 given may be any power of two.\I{section alignment, in
4857 bin}\I{segment alignment, in bin}\I{alignment, in bin sections}
4860 \S{multisec} \i{Multisection}\I{bin, multisection} Support for the \c{bin} Format
4862 The \c{bin} format allows the use of multiple sections, of arbitrary names,
4863 besides the "known" \c{.text}, \c{.data}, and \c{.bss} names.
4865 \b Sections may be designated \i\c{progbits} or \i\c{nobits}. Default
4866 is \c{progbits} (except \c{.bss}, which defaults to \c{nobits},
4869 \b Sections can be aligned at a specified boundary following the previous
4870 section with \c{align=}, or at an arbitrary byte-granular position with
4873 \b Sections can be given a virtual start address, which will be used
4874 for the calculation of all memory references within that section
4877 \b Sections can be ordered using \i\c{follows=}\c{<section>} or
4878 \i\c{vfollows=}\c{<section>} as an alternative to specifying an explicit
4881 \b Arguments to \c{org}, \c{start}, \c{vstart}, and \c{align=} are
4882 critical expressions. See \k{crit}. E.g. \c{align=(1 << ALIGN_SHIFT)}
4883 - \c{ALIGN_SHIFT} must be defined before it is used here.
4885 \b Any code which comes before an explicit \c{SECTION} directive
4886 is directed by default into the \c{.text} section.
4888 \b If an \c{ORG} statement is not given, \c{ORG 0} is used
4891 \b The \c{.bss} section will be placed after the last \c{progbits}
4892 section, unless \c{start=}, \c{vstart=}, \c{follows=}, or \c{vfollows=}
4895 \b All sections are aligned on dword boundaries, unless a different
4896 alignment has been specified.
4898 \b Sections may not overlap.
4900 \b NASM creates the \c{section.<secname>.start} for each section,
4901 which may be used in your code.
4903 \S{map}\i{Map Files}
4905 Map files can be generated in \c{-f bin} format by means of the \c{[map]}
4906 option. Map types of \c{all} (default), \c{brief}, \c{sections}, \c{segments},
4907 or \c{symbols} may be specified. Output may be directed to \c{stdout}
4908 (default), \c{stderr}, or a specified file. E.g.
4909 \c{[map symbols myfile.map]}. No "user form" exists, the square
4910 brackets must be used.
4913 \H{ithfmt} \i\c{ith}: \i{Intel Hex} Output
4915 The \c{ith} file format produces Intel hex-format files. Just as the
4916 \c{bin} format, this is a flat memory image format with no support for
4917 relocation or linking. It is usually used with ROM programmers and
4920 All extensions supported by the \c{bin} file format is also supported by
4921 the \c{ith} file format.
4923 \c{ith} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.ith}.
4926 \H{srecfmt} \i\c{srec}: \i{Motorola S-Records} Output
4928 The \c{srec} file format produces Motorola S-records files. Just as the
4929 \c{bin} format, this is a flat memory image format with no support for
4930 relocation or linking. It is usually used with ROM programmers and
4933 All extensions supported by the \c{bin} file format is also supported by
4934 the \c{srec} file format.
4936 \c{srec} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.srec}.
4939 \H{objfmt} \i\c{obj}: \i{Microsoft OMF}\I{OMF} Object Files
4941 The \c{obj} file format (NASM calls it \c{obj} rather than \c{omf}
4942 for historical reasons) is the one produced by \i{MASM} and
4943 \i{TASM}, which is typically fed to 16-bit DOS linkers to produce
4944 \i\c{.EXE} files. It is also the format used by \i{OS/2}.
4946 \c{obj} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.obj}.
4948 \c{obj} is not exclusively a 16-bit format, though: NASM has full
4949 support for the 32-bit extensions to the format. In particular,
4950 32-bit \c{obj} format files are used by \i{Borland's Win32
4951 compilers}, instead of using Microsoft's newer \i\c{win32} object
4954 The \c{obj} format does not define any special segment names: you
4955 can call your segments anything you like. Typical names for segments
4956 in \c{obj} format files are \c{CODE}, \c{DATA} and \c{BSS}.
4958 If your source file contains code before specifying an explicit
4959 \c{SEGMENT} directive, then NASM will invent its own segment called
4960 \i\c{__NASMDEFSEG} for you.
4962 When you define a segment in an \c{obj} file, NASM defines the
4963 segment name as a symbol as well, so that you can access the segment
4964 address of the segment. So, for example:
4973 \c mov ax,data ; get segment address of data
4974 \c mov ds,ax ; and move it into DS
4975 \c inc word [dvar] ; now this reference will work
4978 The \c{obj} format also enables the use of the \i\c{SEG} and
4979 \i\c{WRT} operators, so that you can write code which does things
4984 \c mov ax,seg foo ; get preferred segment of foo
4986 \c mov ax,data ; a different segment
4988 \c mov ax,[ds:foo] ; this accesses `foo'
4989 \c mov [es:foo wrt data],bx ; so does this
4992 \S{objseg} \c{obj} Extensions to the \c{SEGMENT}
4993 Directive\I{SEGMENT, obj extensions to}
4995 The \c{obj} output format extends the \c{SEGMENT} (or \c{SECTION})
4996 directive to allow you to specify various properties of the segment
4997 you are defining. This is done by appending extra qualifiers to the
4998 end of the segment-definition line. For example,
5000 \c segment code private align=16
5002 defines the segment \c{code}, but also declares it to be a private
5003 segment, and requires that the portion of it described in this code
5004 module must be aligned on a 16-byte boundary.
5006 The available qualifiers are:
5008 \b \i\c{PRIVATE}, \i\c{PUBLIC}, \i\c{COMMON} and \i\c{STACK} specify
5009 the combination characteristics of the segment. \c{PRIVATE} segments
5010 do not get combined with any others by the linker; \c{PUBLIC} and
5011 \c{STACK} segments get concatenated together at link time; and
5012 \c{COMMON} segments all get overlaid on top of each other rather
5013 than stuck end-to-end.
5015 \b \i\c{ALIGN} is used, as shown above, to specify how many low bits
5016 of the segment start address must be forced to zero. The alignment
5017 value given may be any power of two from 1 to 4096; in reality, the
5018 only values supported are 1, 2, 4, 16, 256 and 4096, so if 8 is
5019 specified it will be rounded up to 16, and 32, 64 and 128 will all
5020 be rounded up to 256, and so on. Note that alignment to 4096-byte
5021 boundaries is a \i{PharLap} extension to the format and may not be
5022 supported by all linkers.\I{section alignment, in OBJ}\I{segment
5023 alignment, in OBJ}\I{alignment, in OBJ sections}
5025 \b \i\c{CLASS} can be used to specify the segment class; this feature
5026 indicates to the linker that segments of the same class should be
5027 placed near each other in the output file. The class name can be any
5028 word, e.g. \c{CLASS=CODE}.
5030 \b \i\c{OVERLAY}, like \c{CLASS}, is specified with an arbitrary word
5031 as an argument, and provides overlay information to an
5032 overlay-capable linker.
5034 \b Segments can be declared as \i\c{USE16} or \i\c{USE32}, which has
5035 the effect of recording the choice in the object file and also
5036 ensuring that NASM's default assembly mode when assembling in that
5037 segment is 16-bit or 32-bit respectively.
5039 \b When writing \i{OS/2} object files, you should declare 32-bit
5040 segments as \i\c{FLAT}, which causes the default segment base for
5041 anything in the segment to be the special group \c{FLAT}, and also
5042 defines the group if it is not already defined.
5044 \b The \c{obj} file format also allows segments to be declared as
5045 having a pre-defined absolute segment address, although no linkers
5046 are currently known to make sensible use of this feature;
5047 nevertheless, NASM allows you to declare a segment such as
5048 \c{SEGMENT SCREEN ABSOLUTE=0xB800} if you need to. The \i\c{ABSOLUTE}
5049 and \c{ALIGN} keywords are mutually exclusive.
5051 NASM's default segment attributes are \c{PUBLIC}, \c{ALIGN=1}, no
5052 class, no overlay, and \c{USE16}.
5055 \S{group} \i\c{GROUP}: Defining Groups of Segments\I{segments, groups of}
5057 The \c{obj} format also allows segments to be grouped, so that a
5058 single segment register can be used to refer to all the segments in
5059 a group. NASM therefore supplies the \c{GROUP} directive, whereby
5068 \c ; some uninitialized data
5070 \c group dgroup data bss
5072 which will define a group called \c{dgroup} to contain the segments
5073 \c{data} and \c{bss}. Like \c{SEGMENT}, \c{GROUP} causes the group
5074 name to be defined as a symbol, so that you can refer to a variable
5075 \c{var} in the \c{data} segment as \c{var wrt data} or as \c{var wrt
5076 dgroup}, depending on which segment value is currently in your
5079 If you just refer to \c{var}, however, and \c{var} is declared in a
5080 segment which is part of a group, then NASM will default to giving
5081 you the offset of \c{var} from the beginning of the \e{group}, not
5082 the \e{segment}. Therefore \c{SEG var}, also, will return the group
5083 base rather than the segment base.
5085 NASM will allow a segment to be part of more than one group, but
5086 will generate a warning if you do this. Variables declared in a
5087 segment which is part of more than one group will default to being
5088 relative to the first group that was defined to contain the segment.
5090 A group does not have to contain any segments; you can still make
5091 \c{WRT} references to a group which does not contain the variable
5092 you are referring to. OS/2, for example, defines the special group
5093 \c{FLAT} with no segments in it.
5096 \S{uppercase} \i\c{UPPERCASE}: Disabling Case Sensitivity in Output
5098 Although NASM itself is \i{case sensitive}, some OMF linkers are
5099 not; therefore it can be useful for NASM to output single-case
5100 object files. The \c{UPPERCASE} format-specific directive causes all
5101 segment, group and symbol names that are written to the object file
5102 to be forced to upper case just before being written. Within a
5103 source file, NASM is still case-sensitive; but the object file can
5104 be written entirely in upper case if desired.
5106 \c{UPPERCASE} is used alone on a line; it requires no parameters.
5109 \S{import} \i\c{IMPORT}: Importing DLL Symbols\I{DLL symbols,
5110 importing}\I{symbols, importing from DLLs}
5112 The \c{IMPORT} format-specific directive defines a symbol to be
5113 imported from a DLL, for use if you are writing a DLL's \i{import
5114 library} in NASM. You still need to declare the symbol as \c{EXTERN}
5115 as well as using the \c{IMPORT} directive.
5117 The \c{IMPORT} directive takes two required parameters, separated by
5118 white space, which are (respectively) the name of the symbol you
5119 wish to import and the name of the library you wish to import it
5122 \c import WSAStartup wsock32.dll
5124 A third optional parameter gives the name by which the symbol is
5125 known in the library you are importing it from, in case this is not
5126 the same as the name you wish the symbol to be known by to your code
5127 once you have imported it. For example:
5129 \c import asyncsel wsock32.dll WSAAsyncSelect
5132 \S{export} \i\c{EXPORT}: Exporting DLL Symbols\I{DLL symbols,
5133 exporting}\I{symbols, exporting from DLLs}
5135 The \c{EXPORT} format-specific directive defines a global symbol to
5136 be exported as a DLL symbol, for use if you are writing a DLL in
5137 NASM. You still need to declare the symbol as \c{GLOBAL} as well as
5138 using the \c{EXPORT} directive.
5140 \c{EXPORT} takes one required parameter, which is the name of the
5141 symbol you wish to export, as it was defined in your source file. An
5142 optional second parameter (separated by white space from the first)
5143 gives the \e{external} name of the symbol: the name by which you
5144 wish the symbol to be known to programs using the DLL. If this name
5145 is the same as the internal name, you may leave the second parameter
5148 Further parameters can be given to define attributes of the exported
5149 symbol. These parameters, like the second, are separated by white
5150 space. If further parameters are given, the external name must also
5151 be specified, even if it is the same as the internal name. The
5152 available attributes are:
5154 \b \c{resident} indicates that the exported name is to be kept
5155 resident by the system loader. This is an optimisation for
5156 frequently used symbols imported by name.
5158 \b \c{nodata} indicates that the exported symbol is a function which
5159 does not make use of any initialized data.
5161 \b \c{parm=NNN}, where \c{NNN} is an integer, sets the number of
5162 parameter words for the case in which the symbol is a call gate
5163 between 32-bit and 16-bit segments.
5165 \b An attribute which is just a number indicates that the symbol
5166 should be exported with an identifying number (ordinal), and gives
5172 \c export myfunc TheRealMoreFormalLookingFunctionName
5173 \c export myfunc myfunc 1234 ; export by ordinal
5174 \c export myfunc myfunc resident parm=23 nodata
5177 \S{dotdotstart} \i\c{..start}: Defining the \i{Program Entry
5180 \c{OMF} linkers require exactly one of the object files being linked to
5181 define the program entry point, where execution will begin when the
5182 program is run. If the object file that defines the entry point is
5183 assembled using NASM, you specify the entry point by declaring the
5184 special symbol \c{..start} at the point where you wish execution to
5188 \S{objextern} \c{obj} Extensions to the \c{EXTERN}
5189 Directive\I{EXTERN, obj extensions to}
5191 If you declare an external symbol with the directive
5195 then references such as \c{mov ax,foo} will give you the offset of
5196 \c{foo} from its preferred segment base (as specified in whichever
5197 module \c{foo} is actually defined in). So to access the contents of
5198 \c{foo} you will usually need to do something like
5200 \c mov ax,seg foo ; get preferred segment base
5201 \c mov es,ax ; move it into ES
5202 \c mov ax,[es:foo] ; and use offset `foo' from it
5204 This is a little unwieldy, particularly if you know that an external
5205 is going to be accessible from a given segment or group, say
5206 \c{dgroup}. So if \c{DS} already contained \c{dgroup}, you could
5209 \c mov ax,[foo wrt dgroup]
5211 However, having to type this every time you want to access \c{foo}
5212 can be a pain; so NASM allows you to declare \c{foo} in the
5215 \c extern foo:wrt dgroup
5217 This form causes NASM to pretend that the preferred segment base of
5218 \c{foo} is in fact \c{dgroup}; so the expression \c{seg foo} will
5219 now return \c{dgroup}, and the expression \c{foo} is equivalent to
5222 This \I{default-WRT mechanism}default-\c{WRT} mechanism can be used
5223 to make externals appear to be relative to any group or segment in
5224 your program. It can also be applied to common variables: see
5228 \S{objcommon} \c{obj} Extensions to the \c{COMMON}
5229 Directive\I{COMMON, obj extensions to}
5231 The \c{obj} format allows common variables to be either near\I{near
5232 common variables} or far\I{far common variables}; NASM allows you to
5233 specify which your variables should be by the use of the syntax
5235 \c common nearvar 2:near ; `nearvar' is a near common
5236 \c common farvar 10:far ; and `farvar' is far
5238 Far common variables may be greater in size than 64Kb, and so the
5239 OMF specification says that they are declared as a number of
5240 \e{elements} of a given size. So a 10-byte far common variable could
5241 be declared as ten one-byte elements, five two-byte elements, two
5242 five-byte elements or one ten-byte element.
5244 Some \c{OMF} linkers require the \I{element size, in common
5245 variables}\I{common variables, element size}element size, as well as
5246 the variable size, to match when resolving common variables declared
5247 in more than one module. Therefore NASM must allow you to specify
5248 the element size on your far common variables. This is done by the
5251 \c common c_5by2 10:far 5 ; two five-byte elements
5252 \c common c_2by5 10:far 2 ; five two-byte elements
5254 If no element size is specified, the default is 1. Also, the \c{FAR}
5255 keyword is not required when an element size is specified, since
5256 only far commons may have element sizes at all. So the above
5257 declarations could equivalently be
5259 \c common c_5by2 10:5 ; two five-byte elements
5260 \c common c_2by5 10:2 ; five two-byte elements
5262 In addition to these extensions, the \c{COMMON} directive in \c{obj}
5263 also supports default-\c{WRT} specification like \c{EXTERN} does
5264 (explained in \k{objextern}). So you can also declare things like
5266 \c common foo 10:wrt dgroup
5267 \c common bar 16:far 2:wrt data
5268 \c common baz 24:wrt data:6
5271 \H{win32fmt} \i\c{win32}: Microsoft Win32 Object Files
5273 The \c{win32} output format generates Microsoft Win32 object files,
5274 suitable for passing to Microsoft linkers such as \i{Visual C++}.
5275 Note that Borland Win32 compilers do not use this format, but use
5276 \c{obj} instead (see \k{objfmt}).
5278 \c{win32} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.obj}.
5280 Note that although Microsoft say that Win32 object files follow the
5281 \c{COFF} (Common Object File Format) standard, the object files produced
5282 by Microsoft Win32 compilers are not compatible with COFF linkers
5283 such as DJGPP's, and vice versa. This is due to a difference of
5284 opinion over the precise semantics of PC-relative relocations. To
5285 produce COFF files suitable for DJGPP, use NASM's \c{coff} output
5286 format; conversely, the \c{coff} format does not produce object
5287 files that Win32 linkers can generate correct output from.
5290 \S{win32sect} \c{win32} Extensions to the \c{SECTION}
5291 Directive\I{SECTION, win32 extensions to}
5293 Like the \c{obj} format, \c{win32} allows you to specify additional
5294 information on the \c{SECTION} directive line, to control the type
5295 and properties of sections you declare. Section types and properties
5296 are generated automatically by NASM for the \i{standard section names}
5297 \c{.text}, \c{.data} and \c{.bss}, but may still be overridden by
5300 The available qualifiers are:
5302 \b \c{code}, or equivalently \c{text}, defines the section to be a
5303 code section. This marks the section as readable and executable, but
5304 not writable, and also indicates to the linker that the type of the
5307 \b \c{data} and \c{bss} define the section to be a data section,
5308 analogously to \c{code}. Data sections are marked as readable and
5309 writable, but not executable. \c{data} declares an initialized data
5310 section, whereas \c{bss} declares an uninitialized data section.
5312 \b \c{rdata} declares an initialized data section that is readable
5313 but not writable. Microsoft compilers use this section to place
5316 \b \c{info} defines the section to be an \i{informational section},
5317 which is not included in the executable file by the linker, but may
5318 (for example) pass information \e{to} the linker. For example,
5319 declaring an \c{info}-type section called \i\c{.drectve} causes the
5320 linker to interpret the contents of the section as command-line
5323 \b \c{align=}, used with a trailing number as in \c{obj}, gives the
5324 \I{section alignment, in win32}\I{alignment, in win32
5325 sections}alignment requirements of the section. The maximum you may
5326 specify is 64: the Win32 object file format contains no means to
5327 request a greater section alignment than this. If alignment is not
5328 explicitly specified, the defaults are 16-byte alignment for code
5329 sections, 8-byte alignment for rdata sections and 4-byte alignment
5330 for data (and BSS) sections.
5331 Informational sections get a default alignment of 1 byte (no
5332 alignment), though the value does not matter.
5334 The defaults assumed by NASM if you do not specify the above
5337 \c section .text code align=16
5338 \c section .data data align=4
5339 \c section .rdata rdata align=8
5340 \c section .bss bss align=4
5342 Any other section name is treated by default like \c{.text}.
5344 \S{win32safeseh} \c{win32}: Safe Structured Exception Handling
5346 Among other improvements in Windows XP SP2 and Windows Server 2003
5347 Microsoft has introduced concept of "safe structured exception
5348 handling." General idea is to collect handlers' entry points in
5349 designated read-only table and have alleged entry point verified
5350 against this table prior exception control is passed to the handler. In
5351 order for an executable module to be equipped with such "safe exception
5352 handler table," all object modules on linker command line has to comply
5353 with certain criteria. If one single module among them does not, then
5354 the table in question is omitted and above mentioned run-time checks
5355 will not be performed for application in question. Table omission is by
5356 default silent and therefore can be easily overlooked. One can instruct
5357 linker to refuse to produce binary without such table by passing
5358 \c{/safeseh} command line option.
5360 Without regard to this run-time check merits it's natural to expect
5361 NASM to be capable of generating modules suitable for \c{/safeseh}
5362 linking. From developer's viewpoint the problem is two-fold:
5364 \b how to adapt modules not deploying exception handlers of their own;
5366 \b how to adapt/develop modules utilizing custom exception handling;
5368 Former can be easily achieved with any NASM version by adding following
5369 line to source code:
5373 As of version 2.03 NASM adds this absolute symbol automatically. If
5374 it's not already present to be precise. I.e. if for whatever reason
5375 developer would choose to assign another value in source file, it would
5376 still be perfectly possible.
5378 Registering custom exception handler on the other hand requires certain
5379 "magic." As of version 2.03 additional directive is implemented,
5380 \c{safeseh}, which instructs the assembler to produce appropriately
5381 formatted input data for above mentioned "safe exception handler
5382 table." Its typical use would be:
5385 \c extern _MessageBoxA@16
5386 \c %if __NASM_VERSION_ID__ >= 0x02030000
5387 \c safeseh handler ; register handler as "safe handler"
5390 \c push DWORD 1 ; MB_OKCANCEL
5391 \c push DWORD caption
5394 \c call _MessageBoxA@16
5395 \c sub eax,1 ; incidentally suits as return value
5396 \c ; for exception handler
5400 \c push DWORD handler
5401 \c push DWORD [fs:0]
5402 \c mov DWORD [fs:0],esp ; engage exception handler
5404 \c mov eax,DWORD[eax] ; cause exception
5405 \c pop DWORD [fs:0] ; disengage exception handler
5408 \c text: db 'OK to rethrow, CANCEL to generate core dump',0
5409 \c caption:db 'SEGV',0
5411 \c section .drectve info
5412 \c db '/defaultlib:user32.lib /defaultlib:msvcrt.lib '
5414 As you might imagine, it's perfectly possible to produce .exe binary
5415 with "safe exception handler table" and yet engage unregistered
5416 exception handler. Indeed, handler is engaged by simply manipulating
5417 \c{[fs:0]} location at run-time, something linker has no power over,
5418 run-time that is. It should be explicitly mentioned that such failure
5419 to register handler's entry point with \c{safeseh} directive has
5420 undesired side effect at run-time. If exception is raised and
5421 unregistered handler is to be executed, the application is abruptly
5422 terminated without any notification whatsoever. One can argue that
5423 system could at least have logged some kind "non-safe exception
5424 handler in x.exe at address n" message in event log, but no, literally
5425 no notification is provided and user is left with no clue on what
5426 caused application failure.
5428 Finally, all mentions of linker in this paragraph refer to Microsoft
5429 linker version 7.x and later. Presence of \c{@feat.00} symbol and input
5430 data for "safe exception handler table" causes no backward
5431 incompatibilities and "safeseh" modules generated by NASM 2.03 and
5432 later can still be linked by earlier versions or non-Microsoft linkers.
5434 \S{codeview} Debugging formats for Windows
5435 \I{Windows debugging formats}
5437 The \c{win32} and \c{win64} formats support the Microsoft CodeView
5438 debugging format. Currently CodeView version 8 format is supported
5439 (\i\c{cv8}), but newer versions of the CodeView debugger should be
5440 able to handle this format as well.
5443 \H{win64fmt} \i\c{win64}: Microsoft Win64 Object Files
5445 The \c{win64} output format generates Microsoft Win64 object files,
5446 which is nearly 100% identical to the \c{win32} object format (\k{win32fmt})
5447 with the exception that it is meant to target 64-bit code and the x86-64
5448 platform altogether. This object file is used exactly the same as the \c{win32}
5449 object format (\k{win32fmt}), in NASM, with regard to this exception.
5451 \S{win64pic} \c{win64}: Writing Position-Independent Code
5453 While \c{REL} takes good care of RIP-relative addressing, there is one
5454 aspect that is easy to overlook for a Win64 programmer: indirect
5455 references. Consider a switch dispatch table:
5457 \c jmp qword [dsptch+rax*8]
5463 Even a novice Win64 assembler programmer will soon realize that the code
5464 is not 64-bit savvy. Most notably linker will refuse to link it with
5466 \c 'ADDR32' relocation to '.text' invalid without /LARGEADDRESSAWARE:NO
5468 So [s]he will have to split jmp instruction as following:
5470 \c lea rbx,[rel dsptch]
5471 \c jmp qword [rbx+rax*8]
5473 What happens behind the scene is that effective address in \c{lea} is
5474 encoded relative to instruction pointer, or in perfectly
5475 position-independent manner. But this is only part of the problem!
5476 Trouble is that in .dll context \c{caseN} relocations will make their
5477 way to the final module and might have to be adjusted at .dll load
5478 time. To be specific when it can't be loaded at preferred address. And
5479 when this occurs, pages with such relocations will be rendered private
5480 to current process, which kind of undermines the idea of sharing .dll.
5481 But no worry, it's trivial to fix:
5483 \c lea rbx,[rel dsptch]
5484 \c add rbx,[rbx+rax*8]
5487 \c dsptch: dq case0-dsptch
5491 NASM version 2.03 and later provides another alternative, \c{wrt
5492 ..imagebase} operator, which returns offset from base address of the
5493 current image, be it .exe or .dll module, therefore the name. For those
5494 acquainted with PE-COFF format base address denotes start of
5495 \c{IMAGE_DOS_HEADER} structure. Here is how to implement switch with
5496 these image-relative references:
5498 \c lea rbx,[rel dsptch]
5499 \c mov eax,[rbx+rax*4]
5500 \c sub rbx,dsptch wrt ..imagebase
5504 \c dsptch: dd case0 wrt ..imagebase
5505 \c dd case1 wrt ..imagebase
5507 One can argue that the operator is redundant. Indeed, snippet before
5508 last works just fine with any NASM version and is not even Windows
5509 specific... The real reason for implementing \c{wrt ..imagebase} will
5510 become apparent in next paragraph.
5512 It should be noted that \c{wrt ..imagebase} is defined as 32-bit
5515 \c dd label wrt ..imagebase ; ok
5516 \c dq label wrt ..imagebase ; bad
5517 \c mov eax,label wrt ..imagebase ; ok
5518 \c mov rax,label wrt ..imagebase ; bad
5520 \S{win64seh} \c{win64}: Structured Exception Handling
5522 Structured exception handing in Win64 is completely different matter
5523 from Win32. Upon exception program counter value is noted, and
5524 linker-generated table comprising start and end addresses of all the
5525 functions [in given executable module] is traversed and compared to the
5526 saved program counter. Thus so called \c{UNWIND_INFO} structure is
5527 identified. If it's not found, then offending subroutine is assumed to
5528 be "leaf" and just mentioned lookup procedure is attempted for its
5529 caller. In Win64 leaf function is such function that does not call any
5530 other function \e{nor} modifies any Win64 non-volatile registers,
5531 including stack pointer. The latter ensures that it's possible to
5532 identify leaf function's caller by simply pulling the value from the
5535 While majority of subroutines written in assembler are not calling any
5536 other function, requirement for non-volatile registers' immutability
5537 leaves developer with not more than 7 registers and no stack frame,
5538 which is not necessarily what [s]he counted with. Customarily one would
5539 meet the requirement by saving non-volatile registers on stack and
5540 restoring them upon return, so what can go wrong? If [and only if] an
5541 exception is raised at run-time and no \c{UNWIND_INFO} structure is
5542 associated with such "leaf" function, the stack unwind procedure will
5543 expect to find caller's return address on the top of stack immediately
5544 followed by its frame. Given that developer pushed caller's
5545 non-volatile registers on stack, would the value on top point at some
5546 code segment or even addressable space? Well, developer can attempt
5547 copying caller's return address to the top of stack and this would
5548 actually work in some very specific circumstances. But unless developer
5549 can guarantee that these circumstances are always met, it's more
5550 appropriate to assume worst case scenario, i.e. stack unwind procedure
5551 going berserk. Relevant question is what happens then? Application is
5552 abruptly terminated without any notification whatsoever. Just like in
5553 Win32 case, one can argue that system could at least have logged
5554 "unwind procedure went berserk in x.exe at address n" in event log, but
5555 no, no trace of failure is left.
5557 Now, when we understand significance of the \c{UNWIND_INFO} structure,
5558 let's discuss what's in it and/or how it's processed. First of all it
5559 is checked for presence of reference to custom language-specific
5560 exception handler. If there is one, then it's invoked. Depending on the
5561 return value, execution flow is resumed (exception is said to be
5562 "handled"), \e{or} rest of \c{UNWIND_INFO} structure is processed as
5563 following. Beside optional reference to custom handler, it carries
5564 information about current callee's stack frame and where non-volatile
5565 registers are saved. Information is detailed enough to be able to
5566 reconstruct contents of caller's non-volatile registers upon call to
5567 current callee. And so caller's context is reconstructed, and then
5568 unwind procedure is repeated, i.e. another \c{UNWIND_INFO} structure is
5569 associated, this time, with caller's instruction pointer, which is then
5570 checked for presence of reference to language-specific handler, etc.
5571 The procedure is recursively repeated till exception is handled. As
5572 last resort system "handles" it by generating memory core dump and
5573 terminating the application.
5575 As for the moment of this writing NASM unfortunately does not
5576 facilitate generation of above mentioned detailed information about
5577 stack frame layout. But as of version 2.03 it implements building
5578 blocks for generating structures involved in stack unwinding. As
5579 simplest example, here is how to deploy custom exception handler for
5584 \c extern MessageBoxA
5590 \c mov r9,1 ; MB_OKCANCEL
5592 \c sub eax,1 ; incidentally suits as return value
5593 \c ; for exception handler
5599 \c mov rax,QWORD[rax] ; cause exception
5602 \c text: db 'OK to rethrow, CANCEL to generate core dump',0
5603 \c caption:db 'SEGV',0
5605 \c section .pdata rdata align=4
5606 \c dd main wrt ..imagebase
5607 \c dd main_end wrt ..imagebase
5608 \c dd xmain wrt ..imagebase
5609 \c section .xdata rdata align=8
5610 \c xmain: db 9,0,0,0
5611 \c dd handler wrt ..imagebase
5612 \c section .drectve info
5613 \c db '/defaultlib:user32.lib /defaultlib:msvcrt.lib '
5615 What you see in \c{.pdata} section is element of the "table comprising
5616 start and end addresses of function" along with reference to associated
5617 \c{UNWIND_INFO} structure. And what you see in \c{.xdata} section is
5618 \c{UNWIND_INFO} structure describing function with no frame, but with
5619 designated exception handler. References are \e{required} to be
5620 image-relative (which is the real reason for implementing \c{wrt
5621 ..imagebase} operator). It should be noted that \c{rdata align=n}, as
5622 well as \c{wrt ..imagebase}, are optional in these two segments'
5623 contexts, i.e. can be omitted. Latter means that \e{all} 32-bit
5624 references, not only above listed required ones, placed into these two
5625 segments turn out image-relative. Why is it important to understand?
5626 Developer is allowed to append handler-specific data to \c{UNWIND_INFO}
5627 structure, and if [s]he adds a 32-bit reference, then [s]he will have
5628 to remember to adjust its value to obtain the real pointer.
5630 As already mentioned, in Win64 terms leaf function is one that does not
5631 call any other function \e{nor} modifies any non-volatile register,
5632 including stack pointer. But it's not uncommon that assembler
5633 programmer plans to utilize every single register and sometimes even
5634 have variable stack frame. Is there anything one can do with bare
5635 building blocks? I.e. besides manually composing fully-fledged
5636 \c{UNWIND_INFO} structure, which would surely be considered
5637 error-prone? Yes, there is. Recall that exception handler is called
5638 first, before stack layout is analyzed. As it turned out, it's
5639 perfectly possible to manipulate current callee's context in custom
5640 handler in manner that permits further stack unwinding. General idea is
5641 that handler would not actually "handle" the exception, but instead
5642 restore callee's context, as it was at its entry point and thus mimic
5643 leaf function. In other words, handler would simply undertake part of
5644 unwinding procedure. Consider following example:
5647 \c mov rax,rsp ; copy rsp to volatile register
5648 \c push r15 ; save non-volatile registers
5651 \c mov r11,rsp ; prepare variable stack frame
5654 \c mov QWORD[r11],rax ; check for exceptions
5655 \c mov rsp,r11 ; allocate stack frame
5656 \c mov QWORD[rsp],rax ; save original rsp value
5659 \c mov r11,QWORD[rsp] ; pull original rsp value
5660 \c mov rbp,QWORD[r11-24]
5661 \c mov rbx,QWORD[r11-16]
5662 \c mov r15,QWORD[r11-8]
5663 \c mov rsp,r11 ; destroy frame
5666 The keyword is that up to \c{magic_point} original \c{rsp} value
5667 remains in chosen volatile register and no non-volatile register,
5668 except for \c{rsp}, is modified. While past \c{magic_point} \c{rsp}
5669 remains constant till the very end of the \c{function}. In this case
5670 custom language-specific exception handler would look like this:
5672 \c EXCEPTION_DISPOSITION handler (EXCEPTION_RECORD *rec,ULONG64 frame,
5673 \c CONTEXT *context,DISPATCHER_CONTEXT *disp)
5675 \c if (context->Rip<(ULONG64)magic_point)
5676 \c rsp = (ULONG64 *)context->Rax;
5678 \c { rsp = ((ULONG64 **)context->Rsp)[0];
5679 \c context->Rbp = rsp[-3];
5680 \c context->Rbx = rsp[-2];
5681 \c context->R15 = rsp[-1];
5683 \c context->Rsp = (ULONG64)rsp;
5685 \c memcpy (disp->ContextRecord,context,sizeof(CONTEXT));
5686 \c RtlVirtualUnwind(UNW_FLAG_NHANDLER,disp->ImageBase,
5687 \c dips->ControlPc,disp->FunctionEntry,disp->ContextRecord,
5688 \c &disp->HandlerData,&disp->EstablisherFrame,NULL);
5689 \c return ExceptionContinueSearch;
5692 As custom handler mimics leaf function, corresponding \c{UNWIND_INFO}
5693 structure does not have to contain any information about stack frame
5696 \H{cofffmt} \i\c{coff}: \i{Common Object File Format}
5698 The \c{coff} output type produces \c{COFF} object files suitable for
5699 linking with the \i{DJGPP} linker.
5701 \c{coff} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
5703 The \c{coff} format supports the same extensions to the \c{SECTION}
5704 directive as \c{win32} does, except that the \c{align} qualifier and
5705 the \c{info} section type are not supported.
5707 \H{machofmt} \I{Mach-O}\i\c{macho32} and \i\c{macho64}: \i{Mach Object File Format}
5709 The \c{macho32} and \c{macho64} output formts produces Mach-O
5710 object files suitable for linking with the \i{MacOS X} linker.
5711 \i\c{macho} is a synonym for \c{macho32}.
5713 \c{macho} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
5715 \S{machosect} \c{macho} extensions to the \c{SECTION} Directive
5716 \I{SECTION, macho extensions to}
5718 The \c{macho} output format specifies section names in the format
5719 "\e{segment}\c{,}\e{section}". No spaces are allowed around the
5720 comma. The following flags can also be specified:
5722 \b \c{data} - this section contains initialized data items
5724 \b \c{text} - this section contains code exclusively
5726 \b \c{mixed} - this section contains both code and data
5728 \b \c{bss} - this section is uninitialized and filled with zero
5730 \b \c{align=}\e{alignment} - specify section alignment
5732 The default is \c{data}, unless the section name is \c{__text} or
5733 \c{__bss} in which case the default is \c{text} or \c{bss},
5736 For compatibility with other Unix platforms, the following standard
5737 names are also supported:
5739 \c .text = __TEXT,__text text
5740 \c .rodata = __DATA,__const data
5741 \c .data = __DATA,__data data
5742 \c .bss = __DATA,__bss bss
5744 If the \c{.rodata} section contains no relocations, it is instead put
5745 into the \c{__TEXT,__const} section unless this section has already
5746 been specified explicitly. However, it is probably better to specify
5747 \c{__TEXT,__const} and \c{__DATA,__const} explicitly as appropriate.
5749 \S{machotls} \i{Thread Local Storage in Mach-O}\I{TLS}: \c{macho} special
5750 symbols and \i\c{WRT}
5752 Mach-O defines the following special symbols that can be used on the
5753 right-hand side of the \c{WRT} operator:
5755 \b \c{..tlvp} is used to specify access to thread-local storage.
5757 \b \c{..gotpcrel} is used to specify references to the Global Offset
5758 Table. The GOT is supported in the \c{macho64} format only.
5761 \H{elffmt} \i\c{elf32}, \i\c{elf64}, \i\c{elfx32}: \I{ELF}\I{linux, elf}\i{Executable and Linkable
5762 Format} Object Files
5764 The \c{elf32}, \c{elf64} and \c{elfx32} output formats generate
5765 \c{ELF32 and ELF64} (Executable and Linkable Format) object files, as
5766 used by Linux as well as \i{Unix System V}, including \i{Solaris x86},
5767 \i{UnixWare} and \i{SCO Unix}. \c{elf} provides a default output
5768 file-name extension of \c{.o}. \c{elf} is a synonym for \c{elf32}.
5770 The \c{elfx32} format is used for the \i{x32} ABI, which is a 32-bit
5771 ABI with the CPU in 64-bit mode.
5773 \S{abisect} ELF specific directive \i\c{osabi}
5775 The ELF header specifies the application binary interface for the
5776 target operating system (OSABI). This field can be set by using the
5777 \c{osabi} directive with the numeric value (0-255) of the target
5778 system. If this directive is not used, the default value will be "UNIX
5779 System V ABI" (0) which will work on most systems which support ELF.
5781 \S{elfsect} \c{elf} extensions to the \c{SECTION} Directive
5782 \I{SECTION, elf extensions to}
5784 Like the \c{obj} format, \c{elf} allows you to specify additional
5785 information on the \c{SECTION} directive line, to control the type
5786 and properties of sections you declare. Section types and properties
5787 are generated automatically by NASM for the \i{standard section
5788 names}, but may still be
5789 overridden by these qualifiers.
5791 The available qualifiers are:
5793 \b \i\c{alloc} defines the section to be one which is loaded into
5794 memory when the program is run. \i\c{noalloc} defines it to be one
5795 which is not, such as an informational or comment section.
5797 \b \i\c{exec} defines the section to be one which should have execute
5798 permission when the program is run. \i\c{noexec} defines it as one
5801 \b \i\c{write} defines the section to be one which should be writable
5802 when the program is run. \i\c{nowrite} defines it as one which should
5805 \b \i\c{progbits} defines the section to be one with explicit contents
5806 stored in the object file: an ordinary code or data section, for
5807 example, \i\c{nobits} defines the section to be one with no explicit
5808 contents given, such as a BSS section.
5810 \b \c{align=}, used with a trailing number as in \c{obj}, gives the
5811 \I{section alignment, in elf}\I{alignment, in elf sections}alignment
5812 requirements of the section.
5814 \b \i\c{tls} defines the section to be one which contains
5815 thread local variables.
5817 The defaults assumed by NASM if you do not specify the above
5820 \I\c{.text} \I\c{.rodata} \I\c{.lrodata} \I\c{.data} \I\c{.ldata}
5821 \I\c{.bss} \I\c{.lbss} \I\c{.tdata} \I\c{.tbss} \I\c\{.comment}
5823 \c section .text progbits alloc exec nowrite align=16
5824 \c section .rodata progbits alloc noexec nowrite align=4
5825 \c section .lrodata progbits alloc noexec nowrite align=4
5826 \c section .data progbits alloc noexec write align=4
5827 \c section .ldata progbits alloc noexec write align=4
5828 \c section .bss nobits alloc noexec write align=4
5829 \c section .lbss nobits alloc noexec write align=4
5830 \c section .tdata progbits alloc noexec write align=4 tls
5831 \c section .tbss nobits alloc noexec write align=4 tls
5832 \c section .comment progbits noalloc noexec nowrite align=1
5833 \c section other progbits alloc noexec nowrite align=1
5835 (Any section name other than those in the above table
5836 is treated by default like \c{other} in the above table.
5837 Please note that section names are case sensitive.)
5840 \S{elfwrt} \i{Position-Independent Code}\I{PIC}: \c{macho} Special
5841 Symbols and \i\c{WRT}
5843 Since \c{ELF} does not support segment-base references, the \c{WRT}
5844 operator is not used for its normal purpose; therefore NASM's
5845 \c{elf} output format makes use of \c{WRT} for a different purpose,
5846 namely the PIC-specific \I{relocations, PIC-specific}relocation
5849 \c{elf} defines five special symbols which you can use as the
5850 right-hand side of the \c{WRT} operator to obtain PIC relocation
5851 types. They are \i\c{..gotpc}, \i\c{..gotoff}, \i\c{..got},
5852 \i\c{..plt} and \i\c{..sym}. Their functions are summarized here:
5854 \b Referring to the symbol marking the global offset table base
5855 using \c{wrt ..gotpc} will end up giving the distance from the
5856 beginning of the current section to the global offset table.
5857 (\i\c{_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_} is the standard symbol name used to
5858 refer to the \i{GOT}.) So you would then need to add \i\c{$$} to the
5859 result to get the real address of the GOT.
5861 \b Referring to a location in one of your own sections using \c{wrt
5862 ..gotoff} will give the distance from the beginning of the GOT to
5863 the specified location, so that adding on the address of the GOT
5864 would give the real address of the location you wanted.
5866 \b Referring to an external or global symbol using \c{wrt ..got}
5867 causes the linker to build an entry \e{in} the GOT containing the
5868 address of the symbol, and the reference gives the distance from the
5869 beginning of the GOT to the entry; so you can add on the address of
5870 the GOT, load from the resulting address, and end up with the
5871 address of the symbol.
5873 \b Referring to a procedure name using \c{wrt ..plt} causes the
5874 linker to build a \i{procedure linkage table} entry for the symbol,
5875 and the reference gives the address of the \i{PLT} entry. You can
5876 only use this in contexts which would generate a PC-relative
5877 relocation normally (i.e. as the destination for \c{CALL} or
5878 \c{JMP}), since ELF contains no relocation type to refer to PLT
5881 \b Referring to a symbol name using \c{wrt ..sym} causes NASM to
5882 write an ordinary relocation, but instead of making the relocation
5883 relative to the start of the section and then adding on the offset
5884 to the symbol, it will write a relocation record aimed directly at
5885 the symbol in question. The distinction is a necessary one due to a
5886 peculiarity of the dynamic linker.
5888 A fuller explanation of how to use these relocation types to write
5889 shared libraries entirely in NASM is given in \k{picdll}.
5891 \S{elftls} \i{Thread Local Storage in ELF}\I{TLS}: \c{elf} Special
5892 Symbols and \i\c{WRT}
5894 \b In ELF32 mode, referring to an external or global symbol using
5895 \c{wrt ..tlsie} \I\c{..tlsie}
5896 causes the linker to build an entry \e{in} the GOT containing the
5897 offset of the symbol within the TLS block, so you can access the value
5898 of the symbol with code such as:
5900 \c mov eax,[tid wrt ..tlsie]
5904 \b In ELF64 or ELFx32 mode, referring to an external or global symbol using
5905 \c{wrt ..gottpoff} \I\c{..gottpoff}
5906 causes the linker to build an entry \e{in} the GOT containing the
5907 offset of the symbol within the TLS block, so you can access the value
5908 of the symbol with code such as:
5910 \c mov rax,[rel tid wrt ..gottpoff]
5914 \S{elfglob} \c{elf} Extensions to the \c{GLOBAL} Directive\I{GLOBAL,
5915 elf extensions to}\I{GLOBAL, aoutb extensions to}
5917 \c{ELF} object files can contain more information about a global symbol
5918 than just its address: they can contain the \I{symbol sizes,
5919 specifying}\I{size, of symbols}size of the symbol and its \I{symbol
5920 types, specifying}\I{type, of symbols}type as well. These are not
5921 merely debugger conveniences, but are actually necessary when the
5922 program being written is a \i{shared library}. NASM therefore
5923 supports some extensions to the \c{GLOBAL} directive, allowing you
5924 to specify these features.
5926 You can specify whether a global variable is a function or a data
5927 object by suffixing the name with a colon and the word
5928 \i\c{function} or \i\c{data}. (\i\c{object} is a synonym for
5929 \c{data}.) For example:
5931 \c global hashlookup:function, hashtable:data
5933 exports the global symbol \c{hashlookup} as a function and
5934 \c{hashtable} as a data object.
5936 Optionally, you can control the ELF visibility of the symbol. Just
5937 add one of the visibility keywords: \i\c{default}, \i\c{internal},
5938 \i\c{hidden}, or \i\c{protected}. The default is \i\c{default} of
5939 course. For example, to make \c{hashlookup} hidden:
5941 \c global hashlookup:function hidden
5943 You can also specify the size of the data associated with the
5944 symbol, as a numeric expression (which may involve labels, and even
5945 forward references) after the type specifier. Like this:
5947 \c global hashtable:data (hashtable.end - hashtable)
5950 \c db this,that,theother ; some data here
5953 This makes NASM automatically calculate the length of the table and
5954 place that information into the \c{ELF} symbol table.
5956 Declaring the type and size of global symbols is necessary when
5957 writing shared library code. For more information, see
5961 \S{elfcomm} \c{elf} Extensions to the \c{COMMON} Directive
5962 \I{COMMON, elf extensions to}
5964 \c{ELF} also allows you to specify alignment requirements \I{common
5965 variables, alignment in elf}\I{alignment, of elf common variables}on
5966 common variables. This is done by putting a number (which must be a
5967 power of two) after the name and size of the common variable,
5968 separated (as usual) by a colon. For example, an array of
5969 doublewords would benefit from 4-byte alignment:
5971 \c common dwordarray 128:4
5973 This declares the total size of the array to be 128 bytes, and
5974 requires that it be aligned on a 4-byte boundary.
5977 \S{elf16} 16-bit code and ELF
5978 \I{ELF, 16-bit code and}
5980 The \c{ELF32} specification doesn't provide relocations for 8- and
5981 16-bit values, but the GNU \c{ld} linker adds these as an extension.
5982 NASM can generate GNU-compatible relocations, to allow 16-bit code to
5983 be linked as ELF using GNU \c{ld}. If NASM is used with the
5984 \c{-w+gnu-elf-extensions} option, a warning is issued when one of
5985 these relocations is generated.
5987 \S{elfdbg} Debug formats and ELF
5988 \I{ELF, Debug formats and}
5990 ELF provides debug information in \c{STABS} and \c{DWARF} formats.
5991 Line number information is generated for all executable sections, but please
5992 note that only the ".text" section is executable by default.
5994 \H{aoutfmt} \i\c{aout}: Linux \I{a.out, Linux version}\I{linux, a.out}\c{a.out} Object Files
5996 The \c{aout} format generates \c{a.out} object files, in the form used
5997 by early Linux systems (current Linux systems use ELF, see
5998 \k{elffmt}.) These differ from other \c{a.out} object files in that
5999 the magic number in the first four bytes of the file is
6000 different; also, some implementations of \c{a.out}, for example
6001 NetBSD's, support position-independent code, which Linux's
6002 implementation does not.
6004 \c{a.out} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
6006 \c{a.out} is a very simple object format. It supports no special
6007 directives, no special symbols, no use of \c{SEG} or \c{WRT}, and no
6008 extensions to any standard directives. It supports only the three
6009 \i{standard section names} \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}.
6012 \H{aoutfmt} \i\c{aoutb}: \i{NetBSD}/\i{FreeBSD}/\i{OpenBSD}
6013 \I{a.out, BSD version}\c{a.out} Object Files
6015 The \c{aoutb} format generates \c{a.out} object files, in the form
6016 used by the various free \c{BSD Unix} clones, \c{NetBSD}, \c{FreeBSD}
6017 and \c{OpenBSD}. For simple object files, this object format is exactly
6018 the same as \c{aout} except for the magic number in the first four bytes
6019 of the file. However, the \c{aoutb} format supports
6020 \I{PIC}\i{position-independent code} in the same way as the \c{elf}
6021 format, so you can use it to write \c{BSD} \i{shared libraries}.
6023 \c{aoutb} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
6025 \c{aoutb} supports no special directives, no special symbols, and
6026 only the three \i{standard section names} \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data}
6027 and \i\c{.bss}. However, it also supports the same use of \i\c{WRT} as
6028 \c{elf} does, to provide position-independent code relocation types.
6029 See \k{elfwrt} for full documentation of this feature.
6031 \c{aoutb} also supports the same extensions to the \c{GLOBAL}
6032 directive as \c{elf} does: see \k{elfglob} for documentation of
6036 \H{as86fmt} \c{as86}: \i{Minix}/Linux\I{linux, as86} \i\c{as86} Object Files
6038 The Minix/Linux 16-bit assembler \c{as86} has its own non-standard
6039 object file format. Although its companion linker \i\c{ld86} produces
6040 something close to ordinary \c{a.out} binaries as output, the object
6041 file format used to communicate between \c{as86} and \c{ld86} is not
6044 NASM supports this format, just in case it is useful, as \c{as86}.
6045 \c{as86} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
6047 \c{as86} is a very simple object format (from the NASM user's point
6048 of view). It supports no special directives, no use of \c{SEG} or \c{WRT},
6049 and no extensions to any standard directives. It supports only the three
6050 \i{standard section names} \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}. The
6051 only special symbol supported is \c{..start}.
6054 \H{rdffmt} \I{RDOFF}\i\c{rdf}: \i{Relocatable Dynamic Object File
6057 The \c{rdf} output format produces \c{RDOFF} object files. \c{RDOFF}
6058 (Relocatable Dynamic Object File Format) is a home-grown object-file
6059 format, designed alongside NASM itself and reflecting in its file
6060 format the internal structure of the assembler.
6062 \c{RDOFF} is not used by any well-known operating systems. Those
6063 writing their own systems, however, may well wish to use \c{RDOFF}
6064 as their object format, on the grounds that it is designed primarily
6065 for simplicity and contains very little file-header bureaucracy.
6067 The Unix NASM archive, and the DOS archive which includes sources,
6068 both contain an \I{rdoff subdirectory}\c{rdoff} subdirectory holding
6069 a set of RDOFF utilities: an RDF linker, an \c{RDF} static-library
6070 manager, an RDF file dump utility, and a program which will load and
6071 execute an RDF executable under Linux.
6073 \c{rdf} supports only the \i{standard section names} \i\c{.text},
6074 \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}.
6077 \S{rdflib} Requiring a Library: The \i\c{LIBRARY} Directive
6079 \c{RDOFF} contains a mechanism for an object file to demand a given
6080 library to be linked to the module, either at load time or run time.
6081 This is done by the \c{LIBRARY} directive, which takes one argument
6082 which is the name of the module:
6084 \c library mylib.rdl
6087 \S{rdfmod} Specifying a Module Name: The \i\c{MODULE} Directive
6089 Special \c{RDOFF} header record is used to store the name of the module.
6090 It can be used, for example, by run-time loader to perform dynamic
6091 linking. \c{MODULE} directive takes one argument which is the name
6096 Note that when you statically link modules and tell linker to strip
6097 the symbols from output file, all module names will be stripped too.
6098 To avoid it, you should start module names with \I{$, prefix}\c{$}, like:
6100 \c module $kernel.core
6103 \S{rdfglob} \c{rdf} Extensions to the \c{GLOBAL} Directive\I{GLOBAL,
6106 \c{RDOFF} global symbols can contain additional information needed by
6107 the static linker. You can mark a global symbol as exported, thus
6108 telling the linker do not strip it from target executable or library
6109 file. Like in \c{ELF}, you can also specify whether an exported symbol
6110 is a procedure (function) or data object.
6112 Suffixing the name with a colon and the word \i\c{export} you make the
6115 \c global sys_open:export
6117 To specify that exported symbol is a procedure (function), you add the
6118 word \i\c{proc} or \i\c{function} after declaration:
6120 \c global sys_open:export proc
6122 Similarly, to specify exported data object, add the word \i\c{data}
6123 or \i\c{object} to the directive:
6125 \c global kernel_ticks:export data
6128 \S{rdfimpt} \c{rdf} Extensions to the \c{EXTERN} Directive\I{EXTERN,
6131 By default the \c{EXTERN} directive in \c{RDOFF} declares a "pure external"
6132 symbol (i.e. the static linker will complain if such a symbol is not resolved).
6133 To declare an "imported" symbol, which must be resolved later during a dynamic
6134 linking phase, \c{RDOFF} offers an additional \c{import} modifier. As in
6135 \c{GLOBAL}, you can also specify whether an imported symbol is a procedure
6136 (function) or data object. For example:
6139 \c extern _open:import
6140 \c extern _printf:import proc
6141 \c extern _errno:import data
6143 Here the directive \c{LIBRARY} is also included, which gives the dynamic linker
6144 a hint as to where to find requested symbols.
6147 \H{dbgfmt} \i\c{dbg}: Debugging Format
6149 The \c{dbg} output format is not built into NASM in the default
6150 configuration. If you are building your own NASM executable from the
6151 sources, you can define \i\c{OF_DBG} in \c{output/outform.h} or on the
6152 compiler command line, and obtain the \c{dbg} output format.
6154 The \c{dbg} format does not output an object file as such; instead,
6155 it outputs a text file which contains a complete list of all the
6156 transactions between the main body of NASM and the output-format
6157 back end module. It is primarily intended to aid people who want to
6158 write their own output drivers, so that they can get a clearer idea
6159 of the various requests the main program makes of the output driver,
6160 and in what order they happen.
6162 For simple files, one can easily use the \c{dbg} format like this:
6164 \c nasm -f dbg filename.asm
6166 which will generate a diagnostic file called \c{filename.dbg}.
6167 However, this will not work well on files which were designed for a
6168 different object format, because each object format defines its own
6169 macros (usually user-level forms of directives), and those macros
6170 will not be defined in the \c{dbg} format. Therefore it can be
6171 useful to run NASM twice, in order to do the preprocessing with the
6172 native object format selected:
6174 \c nasm -e -f rdf -o rdfprog.i rdfprog.asm
6175 \c nasm -a -f dbg rdfprog.i
6177 This preprocesses \c{rdfprog.asm} into \c{rdfprog.i}, keeping the
6178 \c{rdf} object format selected in order to make sure RDF special
6179 directives are converted into primitive form correctly. Then the
6180 preprocessed source is fed through the \c{dbg} format to generate
6181 the final diagnostic output.
6183 This workaround will still typically not work for programs intended
6184 for \c{obj} format, because the \c{obj} \c{SEGMENT} and \c{GROUP}
6185 directives have side effects of defining the segment and group names
6186 as symbols; \c{dbg} will not do this, so the program will not
6187 assemble. You will have to work around that by defining the symbols
6188 yourself (using \c{EXTERN}, for example) if you really need to get a
6189 \c{dbg} trace of an \c{obj}-specific source file.
6191 \c{dbg} accepts any section name and any directives at all, and logs
6192 them all to its output file.
6195 \C{16bit} Writing 16-bit Code (DOS, Windows 3/3.1)
6197 This chapter attempts to cover some of the common issues encountered
6198 when writing 16-bit code to run under \c{MS-DOS} or \c{Windows 3.x}. It
6199 covers how to link programs to produce \c{.EXE} or \c{.COM} files,
6200 how to write \c{.SYS} device drivers, and how to interface assembly
6201 language code with 16-bit C compilers and with Borland Pascal.
6204 \H{exefiles} Producing \i\c{.EXE} Files
6206 Any large program written under DOS needs to be built as a \c{.EXE}
6207 file: only \c{.EXE} files have the necessary internal structure
6208 required to span more than one 64K segment. \i{Windows} programs,
6209 also, have to be built as \c{.EXE} files, since Windows does not
6210 support the \c{.COM} format.
6212 In general, you generate \c{.EXE} files by using the \c{obj} output
6213 format to produce one or more \i\c{.OBJ} files, and then linking
6214 them together using a linker. However, NASM also supports the direct
6215 generation of simple DOS \c{.EXE} files using the \c{bin} output
6216 format (by using \c{DB} and \c{DW} to construct the \c{.EXE} file
6217 header), and a macro package is supplied to do this. Thanks to
6218 Yann Guidon for contributing the code for this.
6220 NASM may also support \c{.EXE} natively as another output format in
6224 \S{objexe} Using the \c{obj} Format To Generate \c{.EXE} Files
6226 This section describes the usual method of generating \c{.EXE} files
6227 by linking \c{.OBJ} files together.
6229 Most 16-bit programming language packages come with a suitable
6230 linker; if you have none of these, there is a free linker called
6231 \i{VAL}\I{linker, free}, available in \c{LZH} archive format from
6232 \W{ftp://x2ftp.oulu.fi/pub/msdos/programming/lang/}\i\c{x2ftp.oulu.fi}.
6233 An LZH archiver can be found at
6234 \W{ftp://ftp.simtel.net/pub/simtelnet/msdos/arcers}\i\c{ftp.simtel.net}.
6235 There is another `free' linker (though this one doesn't come with
6236 sources) called \i{FREELINK}, available from
6237 \W{http://www.pcorner.com/tpc/old/3-101.html}\i\c{www.pcorner.com}.
6238 A third, \i\c{djlink}, written by DJ Delorie, is available at
6239 \W{http://www.delorie.com/djgpp/16bit/djlink/}\i\c{www.delorie.com}.
6240 A fourth linker, \i\c{ALINK}, written by Anthony A.J. Williams, is
6241 available at \W{http://alink.sourceforge.net}\i\c{alink.sourceforge.net}.
6243 When linking several \c{.OBJ} files into a \c{.EXE} file, you should
6244 ensure that exactly one of them has a start point defined (using the
6245 \I{program entry point}\i\c{..start} special symbol defined by the
6246 \c{obj} format: see \k{dotdotstart}). If no module defines a start
6247 point, the linker will not know what value to give the entry-point
6248 field in the output file header; if more than one defines a start
6249 point, the linker will not know \e{which} value to use.
6251 An example of a NASM source file which can be assembled to a
6252 \c{.OBJ} file and linked on its own to a \c{.EXE} is given here. It
6253 demonstrates the basic principles of defining a stack, initialising
6254 the segment registers, and declaring a start point. This file is
6255 also provided in the \I{test subdirectory}\c{test} subdirectory of
6256 the NASM archives, under the name \c{objexe.asm}.
6267 This initial piece of code sets up \c{DS} to point to the data
6268 segment, and initializes \c{SS} and \c{SP} to point to the top of
6269 the provided stack. Notice that interrupts are implicitly disabled
6270 for one instruction after a move into \c{SS}, precisely for this
6271 situation, so that there's no chance of an interrupt occurring
6272 between the loads of \c{SS} and \c{SP} and not having a stack to
6275 Note also that the special symbol \c{..start} is defined at the
6276 beginning of this code, which means that will be the entry point
6277 into the resulting executable file.
6283 The above is the main program: load \c{DS:DX} with a pointer to the
6284 greeting message (\c{hello} is implicitly relative to the segment
6285 \c{data}, which was loaded into \c{DS} in the setup code, so the
6286 full pointer is valid), and call the DOS print-string function.
6291 This terminates the program using another DOS system call.
6295 \c hello: db 'hello, world', 13, 10, '$'
6297 The data segment contains the string we want to display.
6299 \c segment stack stack
6303 The above code declares a stack segment containing 64 bytes of
6304 uninitialized stack space, and points \c{stacktop} at the top of it.
6305 The directive \c{segment stack stack} defines a segment \e{called}
6306 \c{stack}, and also of \e{type} \c{STACK}. The latter is not
6307 necessary to the correct running of the program, but linkers are
6308 likely to issue warnings or errors if your program has no segment of
6311 The above file, when assembled into a \c{.OBJ} file, will link on
6312 its own to a valid \c{.EXE} file, which when run will print `hello,
6313 world' and then exit.
6316 \S{binexe} Using the \c{bin} Format To Generate \c{.EXE} Files
6318 The \c{.EXE} file format is simple enough that it's possible to
6319 build a \c{.EXE} file by writing a pure-binary program and sticking
6320 a 32-byte header on the front. This header is simple enough that it
6321 can be generated using \c{DB} and \c{DW} commands by NASM itself, so
6322 that you can use the \c{bin} output format to directly generate
6325 Included in the NASM archives, in the \I{misc subdirectory}\c{misc}
6326 subdirectory, is a file \i\c{exebin.mac} of macros. It defines three
6327 macros: \i\c{EXE_begin}, \i\c{EXE_stack} and \i\c{EXE_end}.
6329 To produce a \c{.EXE} file using this method, you should start by
6330 using \c{%include} to load the \c{exebin.mac} macro package into
6331 your source file. You should then issue the \c{EXE_begin} macro call
6332 (which takes no arguments) to generate the file header data. Then
6333 write code as normal for the \c{bin} format - you can use all three
6334 standard sections \c{.text}, \c{.data} and \c{.bss}. At the end of
6335 the file you should call the \c{EXE_end} macro (again, no arguments),
6336 which defines some symbols to mark section sizes, and these symbols
6337 are referred to in the header code generated by \c{EXE_begin}.
6339 In this model, the code you end up writing starts at \c{0x100}, just
6340 like a \c{.COM} file - in fact, if you strip off the 32-byte header
6341 from the resulting \c{.EXE} file, you will have a valid \c{.COM}
6342 program. All the segment bases are the same, so you are limited to a
6343 64K program, again just like a \c{.COM} file. Note that an \c{ORG}
6344 directive is issued by the \c{EXE_begin} macro, so you should not
6345 explicitly issue one of your own.
6347 You can't directly refer to your segment base value, unfortunately,
6348 since this would require a relocation in the header, and things
6349 would get a lot more complicated. So you should get your segment
6350 base by copying it out of \c{CS} instead.
6352 On entry to your \c{.EXE} file, \c{SS:SP} are already set up to
6353 point to the top of a 2Kb stack. You can adjust the default stack
6354 size of 2Kb by calling the \c{EXE_stack} macro. For example, to
6355 change the stack size of your program to 64 bytes, you would call
6358 A sample program which generates a \c{.EXE} file in this way is
6359 given in the \c{test} subdirectory of the NASM archive, as
6363 \H{comfiles} Producing \i\c{.COM} Files
6365 While large DOS programs must be written as \c{.EXE} files, small
6366 ones are often better written as \c{.COM} files. \c{.COM} files are
6367 pure binary, and therefore most easily produced using the \c{bin}
6371 \S{combinfmt} Using the \c{bin} Format To Generate \c{.COM} Files
6373 \c{.COM} files expect to be loaded at offset \c{100h} into their
6374 segment (though the segment may change). Execution then begins at
6375 \I\c{ORG}\c{100h}, i.e. right at the start of the program. So to
6376 write a \c{.COM} program, you would create a source file looking
6384 \c ; put your code here
6388 \c ; put data items here
6392 \c ; put uninitialized data here
6394 The \c{bin} format puts the \c{.text} section first in the file, so
6395 you can declare data or BSS items before beginning to write code if
6396 you want to and the code will still end up at the front of the file
6399 The BSS (uninitialized data) section does not take up space in the
6400 \c{.COM} file itself: instead, addresses of BSS items are resolved
6401 to point at space beyond the end of the file, on the grounds that
6402 this will be free memory when the program is run. Therefore you
6403 should not rely on your BSS being initialized to all zeros when you
6406 To assemble the above program, you should use a command line like
6408 \c nasm myprog.asm -fbin -o myprog.com
6410 The \c{bin} format would produce a file called \c{myprog} if no
6411 explicit output file name were specified, so you have to override it
6412 and give the desired file name.
6415 \S{comobjfmt} Using the \c{obj} Format To Generate \c{.COM} Files
6417 If you are writing a \c{.COM} program as more than one module, you
6418 may wish to assemble several \c{.OBJ} files and link them together
6419 into a \c{.COM} program. You can do this, provided you have a linker
6420 capable of outputting \c{.COM} files directly (\i{TLINK} does this),
6421 or alternatively a converter program such as \i\c{EXE2BIN} to
6422 transform the \c{.EXE} file output from the linker into a \c{.COM}
6425 If you do this, you need to take care of several things:
6427 \b The first object file containing code should start its code
6428 segment with a line like \c{RESB 100h}. This is to ensure that the
6429 code begins at offset \c{100h} relative to the beginning of the code
6430 segment, so that the linker or converter program does not have to
6431 adjust address references within the file when generating the
6432 \c{.COM} file. Other assemblers use an \i\c{ORG} directive for this
6433 purpose, but \c{ORG} in NASM is a format-specific directive to the
6434 \c{bin} output format, and does not mean the same thing as it does
6435 in MASM-compatible assemblers.
6437 \b You don't need to define a stack segment.
6439 \b All your segments should be in the same group, so that every time
6440 your code or data references a symbol offset, all offsets are
6441 relative to the same segment base. This is because, when a \c{.COM}
6442 file is loaded, all the segment registers contain the same value.
6445 \H{sysfiles} Producing \i\c{.SYS} Files
6447 \i{MS-DOS device drivers} - \c{.SYS} files - are pure binary files,
6448 similar to \c{.COM} files, except that they start at origin zero
6449 rather than \c{100h}. Therefore, if you are writing a device driver
6450 using the \c{bin} format, you do not need the \c{ORG} directive,
6451 since the default origin for \c{bin} is zero. Similarly, if you are
6452 using \c{obj}, you do not need the \c{RESB 100h} at the start of
6455 \c{.SYS} files start with a header structure, containing pointers to
6456 the various routines inside the driver which do the work. This
6457 structure should be defined at the start of the code segment, even
6458 though it is not actually code.
6460 For more information on the format of \c{.SYS} files, and the data
6461 which has to go in the header structure, a list of books is given in
6462 the Frequently Asked Questions list for the newsgroup
6463 \W{news:comp.os.msdos.programmer}\i\c{comp.os.msdos.programmer}.
6466 \H{16c} Interfacing to 16-bit C Programs
6468 This section covers the basics of writing assembly routines that
6469 call, or are called from, C programs. To do this, you would
6470 typically write an assembly module as a \c{.OBJ} file, and link it
6471 with your C modules to produce a \i{mixed-language program}.
6474 \S{16cunder} External Symbol Names
6476 \I{C symbol names}\I{underscore, in C symbols}C compilers have the
6477 convention that the names of all global symbols (functions or data)
6478 they define are formed by prefixing an underscore to the name as it
6479 appears in the C program. So, for example, the function a C
6480 programmer thinks of as \c{printf} appears to an assembly language
6481 programmer as \c{_printf}. This means that in your assembly
6482 programs, you can define symbols without a leading underscore, and
6483 not have to worry about name clashes with C symbols.
6485 If you find the underscores inconvenient, you can define macros to
6486 replace the \c{GLOBAL} and \c{EXTERN} directives as follows:
6502 (These forms of the macros only take one argument at a time; a
6503 \c{%rep} construct could solve this.)
6505 If you then declare an external like this:
6509 then the macro will expand it as
6512 \c %define printf _printf
6514 Thereafter, you can reference \c{printf} as if it was a symbol, and
6515 the preprocessor will put the leading underscore on where necessary.
6517 The \c{cglobal} macro works similarly. You must use \c{cglobal}
6518 before defining the symbol in question, but you would have had to do
6519 that anyway if you used \c{GLOBAL}.
6521 Also see \k{opt-pfix}.
6523 \S{16cmodels} \i{Memory Models}
6525 NASM contains no mechanism to support the various C memory models
6526 directly; you have to keep track yourself of which one you are
6527 writing for. This means you have to keep track of the following
6530 \b In models using a single code segment (tiny, small and compact),
6531 functions are near. This means that function pointers, when stored
6532 in data segments or pushed on the stack as function arguments, are
6533 16 bits long and contain only an offset field (the \c{CS} register
6534 never changes its value, and always gives the segment part of the
6535 full function address), and that functions are called using ordinary
6536 near \c{CALL} instructions and return using \c{RETN} (which, in
6537 NASM, is synonymous with \c{RET} anyway). This means both that you
6538 should write your own routines to return with \c{RETN}, and that you
6539 should call external C routines with near \c{CALL} instructions.
6541 \b In models using more than one code segment (medium, large and
6542 huge), functions are far. This means that function pointers are 32
6543 bits long (consisting of a 16-bit offset followed by a 16-bit
6544 segment), and that functions are called using \c{CALL FAR} (or
6545 \c{CALL seg:offset}) and return using \c{RETF}. Again, you should
6546 therefore write your own routines to return with \c{RETF} and use
6547 \c{CALL FAR} to call external routines.
6549 \b In models using a single data segment (tiny, small and medium),
6550 data pointers are 16 bits long, containing only an offset field (the
6551 \c{DS} register doesn't change its value, and always gives the
6552 segment part of the full data item address).
6554 \b In models using more than one data segment (compact, large and
6555 huge), data pointers are 32 bits long, consisting of a 16-bit offset
6556 followed by a 16-bit segment. You should still be careful not to
6557 modify \c{DS} in your routines without restoring it afterwards, but
6558 \c{ES} is free for you to use to access the contents of 32-bit data
6559 pointers you are passed.
6561 \b The huge memory model allows single data items to exceed 64K in
6562 size. In all other memory models, you can access the whole of a data
6563 item just by doing arithmetic on the offset field of the pointer you
6564 are given, whether a segment field is present or not; in huge model,
6565 you have to be more careful of your pointer arithmetic.
6567 \b In most memory models, there is a \e{default} data segment, whose
6568 segment address is kept in \c{DS} throughout the program. This data
6569 segment is typically the same segment as the stack, kept in \c{SS},
6570 so that functions' local variables (which are stored on the stack)
6571 and global data items can both be accessed easily without changing
6572 \c{DS}. Particularly large data items are typically stored in other
6573 segments. However, some memory models (though not the standard
6574 ones, usually) allow the assumption that \c{SS} and \c{DS} hold the
6575 same value to be removed. Be careful about functions' local
6576 variables in this latter case.
6578 In models with a single code segment, the segment is called
6579 \i\c{_TEXT}, so your code segment must also go by this name in order
6580 to be linked into the same place as the main code segment. In models
6581 with a single data segment, or with a default data segment, it is
6585 \S{16cfunc} Function Definitions and Function Calls
6587 \I{functions, C calling convention}The \i{C calling convention} in
6588 16-bit programs is as follows. In the following description, the
6589 words \e{caller} and \e{callee} are used to denote the function
6590 doing the calling and the function which gets called.
6592 \b The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
6593 after another, in reverse order (right to left, so that the first
6594 argument specified to the function is pushed last).
6596 \b The caller then executes a \c{CALL} instruction to pass control
6597 to the callee. This \c{CALL} is either near or far depending on the
6600 \b The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
6601 actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access their
6602 parameters) starts by saving the value of \c{SP} in \c{BP} so as to
6603 be able to use \c{BP} as a base pointer to find its parameters on
6604 the stack. However, the caller was probably doing this too, so part
6605 of the calling convention states that \c{BP} must be preserved by
6606 any C function. Hence the callee, if it is going to set up \c{BP} as
6607 a \i\e{frame pointer}, must push the previous value first.
6609 \b The callee may then access its parameters relative to \c{BP}.
6610 The word at \c{[BP]} holds the previous value of \c{BP} as it was
6611 pushed; the next word, at \c{[BP+2]}, holds the offset part of the
6612 return address, pushed implicitly by \c{CALL}. In a small-model
6613 (near) function, the parameters start after that, at \c{[BP+4]}; in
6614 a large-model (far) function, the segment part of the return address
6615 lives at \c{[BP+4]}, and the parameters begin at \c{[BP+6]}. The
6616 leftmost parameter of the function, since it was pushed last, is
6617 accessible at this offset from \c{BP}; the others follow, at
6618 successively greater offsets. Thus, in a function such as \c{printf}
6619 which takes a variable number of parameters, the pushing of the
6620 parameters in reverse order means that the function knows where to
6621 find its first parameter, which tells it the number and type of the
6624 \b The callee may also wish to decrease \c{SP} further, so as to
6625 allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then be
6626 accessible at negative offsets from \c{BP}.
6628 \b The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
6629 leave the value in \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{DX:AX} depending on the size
6630 of the value. Floating-point results are sometimes (depending on the
6631 compiler) returned in \c{ST0}.
6633 \b Once the callee has finished processing, it restores \c{SP} from
6634 \c{BP} if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the previous
6635 value of \c{BP}, and returns via \c{RETN} or \c{RETF} depending on
6638 \b When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
6639 parameters are still on the stack, so it typically adds an immediate
6640 constant to \c{SP} to remove them (instead of executing a number of
6641 slow \c{POP} instructions). Thus, if a function is accidentally
6642 called with the wrong number of parameters due to a prototype
6643 mismatch, the stack will still be returned to a sensible state since
6644 the caller, which \e{knows} how many parameters it pushed, does the
6647 It is instructive to compare this calling convention with that for
6648 Pascal programs (described in \k{16bpfunc}). Pascal has a simpler
6649 convention, since no functions have variable numbers of parameters.
6650 Therefore the callee knows how many parameters it should have been
6651 passed, and is able to deallocate them from the stack itself by
6652 passing an immediate argument to the \c{RET} or \c{RETF}
6653 instruction, so the caller does not have to do it. Also, the
6654 parameters are pushed in left-to-right order, not right-to-left,
6655 which means that a compiler can give better guarantees about
6656 sequence points without performance suffering.
6658 Thus, you would define a function in C style in the following way.
6659 The following example is for small model:
6666 \c sub sp,0x40 ; 64 bytes of local stack space
6667 \c mov bx,[bp+4] ; first parameter to function
6671 \c mov sp,bp ; undo "sub sp,0x40" above
6675 For a large-model function, you would replace \c{RET} by \c{RETF},
6676 and look for the first parameter at \c{[BP+6]} instead of
6677 \c{[BP+4]}. Of course, if one of the parameters is a pointer, then
6678 the offsets of \e{subsequent} parameters will change depending on
6679 the memory model as well: far pointers take up four bytes on the
6680 stack when passed as a parameter, whereas near pointers take up two.
6682 At the other end of the process, to call a C function from your
6683 assembly code, you would do something like this:
6687 \c ; and then, further down...
6689 \c push word [myint] ; one of my integer variables
6690 \c push word mystring ; pointer into my data segment
6692 \c add sp,byte 4 ; `byte' saves space
6694 \c ; then those data items...
6699 \c mystring db 'This number -> %d <- should be 1234',10,0
6701 This piece of code is the small-model assembly equivalent of the C
6704 \c int myint = 1234;
6705 \c printf("This number -> %d <- should be 1234\n", myint);
6707 In large model, the function-call code might look more like this. In
6708 this example, it is assumed that \c{DS} already holds the segment
6709 base of the segment \c{_DATA}. If not, you would have to initialize
6712 \c push word [myint]
6713 \c push word seg mystring ; Now push the segment, and...
6714 \c push word mystring ; ... offset of "mystring"
6718 The integer value still takes up one word on the stack, since large
6719 model does not affect the size of the \c{int} data type. The first
6720 argument (pushed last) to \c{printf}, however, is a data pointer,
6721 and therefore has to contain a segment and offset part. The segment
6722 should be stored second in memory, and therefore must be pushed
6723 first. (Of course, \c{PUSH DS} would have been a shorter instruction
6724 than \c{PUSH WORD SEG mystring}, if \c{DS} was set up as the above
6725 example assumed.) Then the actual call becomes a far call, since
6726 functions expect far calls in large model; and \c{SP} has to be
6727 increased by 6 rather than 4 afterwards to make up for the extra
6731 \S{16cdata} Accessing Data Items
6733 To get at the contents of C variables, or to declare variables which
6734 C can access, you need only declare the names as \c{GLOBAL} or
6735 \c{EXTERN}. (Again, the names require leading underscores, as stated
6736 in \k{16cunder}.) Thus, a C variable declared as \c{int i} can be
6737 accessed from assembler as
6743 And to declare your own integer variable which C programs can access
6744 as \c{extern int j}, you do this (making sure you are assembling in
6745 the \c{_DATA} segment, if necessary):
6751 To access a C array, you need to know the size of the components of
6752 the array. For example, \c{int} variables are two bytes long, so if
6753 a C program declares an array as \c{int a[10]}, you can access
6754 \c{a[3]} by coding \c{mov ax,[_a+6]}. (The byte offset 6 is obtained
6755 by multiplying the desired array index, 3, by the size of the array
6756 element, 2.) The sizes of the C base types in 16-bit compilers are:
6757 1 for \c{char}, 2 for \c{short} and \c{int}, 4 for \c{long} and
6758 \c{float}, and 8 for \c{double}.
6760 To access a C \i{data structure}, you need to know the offset from
6761 the base of the structure to the field you are interested in. You
6762 can either do this by converting the C structure definition into a
6763 NASM structure definition (using \i\c{STRUC}), or by calculating the
6764 one offset and using just that.
6766 To do either of these, you should read your C compiler's manual to
6767 find out how it organizes data structures. NASM gives no special
6768 alignment to structure members in its own \c{STRUC} macro, so you
6769 have to specify alignment yourself if the C compiler generates it.
6770 Typically, you might find that a structure like
6777 might be four bytes long rather than three, since the \c{int} field
6778 would be aligned to a two-byte boundary. However, this sort of
6779 feature tends to be a configurable option in the C compiler, either
6780 using command-line options or \c{#pragma} lines, so you have to find
6781 out how your own compiler does it.
6784 \S{16cmacro} \i\c{c16.mac}: Helper Macros for the 16-bit C Interface
6786 Included in the NASM archives, in the \I{misc subdirectory}\c{misc}
6787 directory, is a file \c{c16.mac} of macros. It defines three macros:
6788 \i\c{proc}, \i\c{arg} and \i\c{endproc}. These are intended to be
6789 used for C-style procedure definitions, and they automate a lot of
6790 the work involved in keeping track of the calling convention.
6792 (An alternative, TASM compatible form of \c{arg} is also now built
6793 into NASM's preprocessor. See \k{stackrel} for details.)
6795 An example of an assembly function using the macro set is given
6802 \c mov ax,[bp + %$i]
6803 \c mov bx,[bp + %$j]
6808 This defines \c{_nearproc} to be a procedure taking two arguments,
6809 the first (\c{i}) an integer and the second (\c{j}) a pointer to an
6810 integer. It returns \c{i + *j}.
6812 Note that the \c{arg} macro has an \c{EQU} as the first line of its
6813 expansion, and since the label before the macro call gets prepended
6814 to the first line of the expanded macro, the \c{EQU} works, defining
6815 \c{%$i} to be an offset from \c{BP}. A context-local variable is
6816 used, local to the context pushed by the \c{proc} macro and popped
6817 by the \c{endproc} macro, so that the same argument name can be used
6818 in later procedures. Of course, you don't \e{have} to do that.
6820 The macro set produces code for near functions (tiny, small and
6821 compact-model code) by default. You can have it generate far
6822 functions (medium, large and huge-model code) by means of coding
6823 \I\c{FARCODE}\c{%define FARCODE}. This changes the kind of return
6824 instruction generated by \c{endproc}, and also changes the starting
6825 point for the argument offsets. The macro set contains no intrinsic
6826 dependency on whether data pointers are far or not.
6828 \c{arg} can take an optional parameter, giving the size of the
6829 argument. If no size is given, 2 is assumed, since it is likely that
6830 many function parameters will be of type \c{int}.
6832 The large-model equivalent of the above function would look like this:
6840 \c mov ax,[bp + %$i]
6841 \c mov bx,[bp + %$j]
6842 \c mov es,[bp + %$j + 2]
6847 This makes use of the argument to the \c{arg} macro to define a
6848 parameter of size 4, because \c{j} is now a far pointer. When we
6849 load from \c{j}, we must load a segment and an offset.
6852 \H{16bp} Interfacing to \i{Borland Pascal} Programs
6854 Interfacing to Borland Pascal programs is similar in concept to
6855 interfacing to 16-bit C programs. The differences are:
6857 \b The leading underscore required for interfacing to C programs is
6858 not required for Pascal.
6860 \b The memory model is always large: functions are far, data
6861 pointers are far, and no data item can be more than 64K long.
6862 (Actually, some functions are near, but only those functions that
6863 are local to a Pascal unit and never called from outside it. All
6864 assembly functions that Pascal calls, and all Pascal functions that
6865 assembly routines are able to call, are far.) However, all static
6866 data declared in a Pascal program goes into the default data
6867 segment, which is the one whose segment address will be in \c{DS}
6868 when control is passed to your assembly code. The only things that
6869 do not live in the default data segment are local variables (they
6870 live in the stack segment) and dynamically allocated variables. All
6871 data \e{pointers}, however, are far.
6873 \b The function calling convention is different - described below.
6875 \b Some data types, such as strings, are stored differently.
6877 \b There are restrictions on the segment names you are allowed to
6878 use - Borland Pascal will ignore code or data declared in a segment
6879 it doesn't like the name of. The restrictions are described below.
6882 \S{16bpfunc} The Pascal Calling Convention
6884 \I{functions, Pascal calling convention}\I{Pascal calling
6885 convention}The 16-bit Pascal calling convention is as follows. In
6886 the following description, the words \e{caller} and \e{callee} are
6887 used to denote the function doing the calling and the function which
6890 \b The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
6891 after another, in normal order (left to right, so that the first
6892 argument specified to the function is pushed first).
6894 \b The caller then executes a far \c{CALL} instruction to pass
6895 control to the callee.
6897 \b The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
6898 actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access their
6899 parameters) starts by saving the value of \c{SP} in \c{BP} so as to
6900 be able to use \c{BP} as a base pointer to find its parameters on
6901 the stack. However, the caller was probably doing this too, so part
6902 of the calling convention states that \c{BP} must be preserved by
6903 any function. Hence the callee, if it is going to set up \c{BP} as a
6904 \i{frame pointer}, must push the previous value first.
6906 \b The callee may then access its parameters relative to \c{BP}.
6907 The word at \c{[BP]} holds the previous value of \c{BP} as it was
6908 pushed. The next word, at \c{[BP+2]}, holds the offset part of the
6909 return address, and the next one at \c{[BP+4]} the segment part. The
6910 parameters begin at \c{[BP+6]}. The rightmost parameter of the
6911 function, since it was pushed last, is accessible at this offset
6912 from \c{BP}; the others follow, at successively greater offsets.
6914 \b The callee may also wish to decrease \c{SP} further, so as to
6915 allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then be
6916 accessible at negative offsets from \c{BP}.
6918 \b The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
6919 leave the value in \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{DX:AX} depending on the size
6920 of the value. Floating-point results are returned in \c{ST0}.
6921 Results of type \c{Real} (Borland's own custom floating-point data
6922 type, not handled directly by the FPU) are returned in \c{DX:BX:AX}.
6923 To return a result of type \c{String}, the caller pushes a pointer
6924 to a temporary string before pushing the parameters, and the callee
6925 places the returned string value at that location. The pointer is
6926 not a parameter, and should not be removed from the stack by the
6927 \c{RETF} instruction.
6929 \b Once the callee has finished processing, it restores \c{SP} from
6930 \c{BP} if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the previous
6931 value of \c{BP}, and returns via \c{RETF}. It uses the form of
6932 \c{RETF} with an immediate parameter, giving the number of bytes
6933 taken up by the parameters on the stack. This causes the parameters
6934 to be removed from the stack as a side effect of the return
6937 \b When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
6938 parameters have already been removed from the stack, so it needs to
6941 Thus, you would define a function in Pascal style, taking two
6942 \c{Integer}-type parameters, in the following way:
6948 \c sub sp,0x40 ; 64 bytes of local stack space
6949 \c mov bx,[bp+8] ; first parameter to function
6950 \c mov bx,[bp+6] ; second parameter to function
6954 \c mov sp,bp ; undo "sub sp,0x40" above
6956 \c retf 4 ; total size of params is 4
6958 At the other end of the process, to call a Pascal function from your
6959 assembly code, you would do something like this:
6963 \c ; and then, further down...
6965 \c push word seg mystring ; Now push the segment, and...
6966 \c push word mystring ; ... offset of "mystring"
6967 \c push word [myint] ; one of my variables
6968 \c call far SomeFunc
6970 This is equivalent to the Pascal code
6972 \c procedure SomeFunc(String: PChar; Int: Integer);
6973 \c SomeFunc(@mystring, myint);
6976 \S{16bpseg} Borland Pascal \I{segment names, Borland Pascal}Segment
6979 Since Borland Pascal's internal unit file format is completely
6980 different from \c{OBJ}, it only makes a very sketchy job of actually
6981 reading and understanding the various information contained in a
6982 real \c{OBJ} file when it links that in. Therefore an object file
6983 intended to be linked to a Pascal program must obey a number of
6986 \b Procedures and functions must be in a segment whose name is
6987 either \c{CODE}, \c{CSEG}, or something ending in \c{_TEXT}.
6989 \b initialized data must be in a segment whose name is either
6990 \c{CONST} or something ending in \c{_DATA}.
6992 \b Uninitialized data must be in a segment whose name is either
6993 \c{DATA}, \c{DSEG}, or something ending in \c{_BSS}.
6995 \b Any other segments in the object file are completely ignored.
6996 \c{GROUP} directives and segment attributes are also ignored.
6999 \S{16bpmacro} Using \i\c{c16.mac} With Pascal Programs
7001 The \c{c16.mac} macro package, described in \k{16cmacro}, can also
7002 be used to simplify writing functions to be called from Pascal
7003 programs, if you code \I\c{PASCAL}\c{%define PASCAL}. This
7004 definition ensures that functions are far (it implies
7005 \i\c{FARCODE}), and also causes procedure return instructions to be
7006 generated with an operand.
7008 Defining \c{PASCAL} does not change the code which calculates the
7009 argument offsets; you must declare your function's arguments in
7010 reverse order. For example:
7018 \c mov ax,[bp + %$i]
7019 \c mov bx,[bp + %$j]
7020 \c mov es,[bp + %$j + 2]
7025 This defines the same routine, conceptually, as the example in
7026 \k{16cmacro}: it defines a function taking two arguments, an integer
7027 and a pointer to an integer, which returns the sum of the integer
7028 and the contents of the pointer. The only difference between this
7029 code and the large-model C version is that \c{PASCAL} is defined
7030 instead of \c{FARCODE}, and that the arguments are declared in
7034 \C{32bit} Writing 32-bit Code (Unix, Win32, DJGPP)
7036 This chapter attempts to cover some of the common issues involved
7037 when writing 32-bit code, to run under \i{Win32} or Unix, or to be
7038 linked with C code generated by a Unix-style C compiler such as
7039 \i{DJGPP}. It covers how to write assembly code to interface with
7040 32-bit C routines, and how to write position-independent code for
7043 Almost all 32-bit code, and in particular all code running under
7044 \c{Win32}, \c{DJGPP} or any of the PC Unix variants, runs in \I{flat
7045 memory model}\e{flat} memory model. This means that the segment registers
7046 and paging have already been set up to give you the same 32-bit 4Gb
7047 address space no matter what segment you work relative to, and that
7048 you should ignore all segment registers completely. When writing
7049 flat-model application code, you never need to use a segment
7050 override or modify any segment register, and the code-section
7051 addresses you pass to \c{CALL} and \c{JMP} live in the same address
7052 space as the data-section addresses you access your variables by and
7053 the stack-section addresses you access local variables and procedure
7054 parameters by. Every address is 32 bits long and contains only an
7058 \H{32c} Interfacing to 32-bit C Programs
7060 A lot of the discussion in \k{16c}, about interfacing to 16-bit C
7061 programs, still applies when working in 32 bits. The absence of
7062 memory models or segmentation worries simplifies things a lot.
7065 \S{32cunder} External Symbol Names
7067 Most 32-bit C compilers share the convention used by 16-bit
7068 compilers, that the names of all global symbols (functions or data)
7069 they define are formed by prefixing an underscore to the name as it
7070 appears in the C program. However, not all of them do: the \c{ELF}
7071 specification states that C symbols do \e{not} have a leading
7072 underscore on their assembly-language names.
7074 The older Linux \c{a.out} C compiler, all \c{Win32} compilers,
7075 \c{DJGPP}, and \c{NetBSD} and \c{FreeBSD}, all use the leading
7076 underscore; for these compilers, the macros \c{cextern} and
7077 \c{cglobal}, as given in \k{16cunder}, will still work. For \c{ELF},
7078 though, the leading underscore should not be used.
7080 See also \k{opt-pfix}.
7082 \S{32cfunc} Function Definitions and Function Calls
7084 \I{functions, C calling convention}The \i{C calling convention}
7085 in 32-bit programs is as follows. In the following description,
7086 the words \e{caller} and \e{callee} are used to denote
7087 the function doing the calling and the function which gets called.
7089 \b The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
7090 after another, in reverse order (right to left, so that the first
7091 argument specified to the function is pushed last).
7093 \b The caller then executes a near \c{CALL} instruction to pass
7094 control to the callee.
7096 \b The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
7097 actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access their
7098 parameters) starts by saving the value of \c{ESP} in \c{EBP} so as
7099 to be able to use \c{EBP} as a base pointer to find its parameters
7100 on the stack. However, the caller was probably doing this too, so
7101 part of the calling convention states that \c{EBP} must be preserved
7102 by any C function. Hence the callee, if it is going to set up
7103 \c{EBP} as a \i{frame pointer}, must push the previous value first.
7105 \b The callee may then access its parameters relative to \c{EBP}.
7106 The doubleword at \c{[EBP]} holds the previous value of \c{EBP} as
7107 it was pushed; the next doubleword, at \c{[EBP+4]}, holds the return
7108 address, pushed implicitly by \c{CALL}. The parameters start after
7109 that, at \c{[EBP+8]}. The leftmost parameter of the function, since
7110 it was pushed last, is accessible at this offset from \c{EBP}; the
7111 others follow, at successively greater offsets. Thus, in a function
7112 such as \c{printf} which takes a variable number of parameters, the
7113 pushing of the parameters in reverse order means that the function
7114 knows where to find its first parameter, which tells it the number
7115 and type of the remaining ones.
7117 \b The callee may also wish to decrease \c{ESP} further, so as to
7118 allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then be
7119 accessible at negative offsets from \c{EBP}.
7121 \b The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
7122 leave the value in \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{EAX} depending on the size
7123 of the value. Floating-point results are typically returned in
7126 \b Once the callee has finished processing, it restores \c{ESP} from
7127 \c{EBP} if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the previous
7128 value of \c{EBP}, and returns via \c{RET} (equivalently, \c{RETN}).
7130 \b When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
7131 parameters are still on the stack, so it typically adds an immediate
7132 constant to \c{ESP} to remove them (instead of executing a number of
7133 slow \c{POP} instructions). Thus, if a function is accidentally
7134 called with the wrong number of parameters due to a prototype
7135 mismatch, the stack will still be returned to a sensible state since
7136 the caller, which \e{knows} how many parameters it pushed, does the
7139 There is an alternative calling convention used by Win32 programs
7140 for Windows API calls, and also for functions called \e{by} the
7141 Windows API such as window procedures: they follow what Microsoft
7142 calls the \c{__stdcall} convention. This is slightly closer to the
7143 Pascal convention, in that the callee clears the stack by passing a
7144 parameter to the \c{RET} instruction. However, the parameters are
7145 still pushed in right-to-left order.
7147 Thus, you would define a function in C style in the following way:
7154 \c sub esp,0x40 ; 64 bytes of local stack space
7155 \c mov ebx,[ebp+8] ; first parameter to function
7159 \c leave ; mov esp,ebp / pop ebp
7162 At the other end of the process, to call a C function from your
7163 assembly code, you would do something like this:
7167 \c ; and then, further down...
7169 \c push dword [myint] ; one of my integer variables
7170 \c push dword mystring ; pointer into my data segment
7172 \c add esp,byte 8 ; `byte' saves space
7174 \c ; then those data items...
7179 \c mystring db 'This number -> %d <- should be 1234',10,0
7181 This piece of code is the assembly equivalent of the C code
7183 \c int myint = 1234;
7184 \c printf("This number -> %d <- should be 1234\n", myint);
7187 \S{32cdata} Accessing Data Items
7189 To get at the contents of C variables, or to declare variables which
7190 C can access, you need only declare the names as \c{GLOBAL} or
7191 \c{EXTERN}. (Again, the names require leading underscores, as stated
7192 in \k{32cunder}.) Thus, a C variable declared as \c{int i} can be
7193 accessed from assembler as
7198 And to declare your own integer variable which C programs can access
7199 as \c{extern int j}, you do this (making sure you are assembling in
7200 the \c{_DATA} segment, if necessary):
7205 To access a C array, you need to know the size of the components of
7206 the array. For example, \c{int} variables are four bytes long, so if
7207 a C program declares an array as \c{int a[10]}, you can access
7208 \c{a[3]} by coding \c{mov ax,[_a+12]}. (The byte offset 12 is obtained
7209 by multiplying the desired array index, 3, by the size of the array
7210 element, 4.) The sizes of the C base types in 32-bit compilers are:
7211 1 for \c{char}, 2 for \c{short}, 4 for \c{int}, \c{long} and
7212 \c{float}, and 8 for \c{double}. Pointers, being 32-bit addresses,
7213 are also 4 bytes long.
7215 To access a C \i{data structure}, you need to know the offset from
7216 the base of the structure to the field you are interested in. You
7217 can either do this by converting the C structure definition into a
7218 NASM structure definition (using \c{STRUC}), or by calculating the
7219 one offset and using just that.
7221 To do either of these, you should read your C compiler's manual to
7222 find out how it organizes data structures. NASM gives no special
7223 alignment to structure members in its own \i\c{STRUC} macro, so you
7224 have to specify alignment yourself if the C compiler generates it.
7225 Typically, you might find that a structure like
7232 might be eight bytes long rather than five, since the \c{int} field
7233 would be aligned to a four-byte boundary. However, this sort of
7234 feature is sometimes a configurable option in the C compiler, either
7235 using command-line options or \c{#pragma} lines, so you have to find
7236 out how your own compiler does it.
7239 \S{32cmacro} \i\c{c32.mac}: Helper Macros for the 32-bit C Interface
7241 Included in the NASM archives, in the \I{misc directory}\c{misc}
7242 directory, is a file \c{c32.mac} of macros. It defines three macros:
7243 \i\c{proc}, \i\c{arg} and \i\c{endproc}. These are intended to be
7244 used for C-style procedure definitions, and they automate a lot of
7245 the work involved in keeping track of the calling convention.
7247 An example of an assembly function using the macro set is given
7254 \c mov eax,[ebp + %$i]
7255 \c mov ebx,[ebp + %$j]
7260 This defines \c{_proc32} to be a procedure taking two arguments, the
7261 first (\c{i}) an integer and the second (\c{j}) a pointer to an
7262 integer. It returns \c{i + *j}.
7264 Note that the \c{arg} macro has an \c{EQU} as the first line of its
7265 expansion, and since the label before the macro call gets prepended
7266 to the first line of the expanded macro, the \c{EQU} works, defining
7267 \c{%$i} to be an offset from \c{BP}. A context-local variable is
7268 used, local to the context pushed by the \c{proc} macro and popped
7269 by the \c{endproc} macro, so that the same argument name can be used
7270 in later procedures. Of course, you don't \e{have} to do that.
7272 \c{arg} can take an optional parameter, giving the size of the
7273 argument. If no size is given, 4 is assumed, since it is likely that
7274 many function parameters will be of type \c{int} or pointers.
7277 \H{picdll} Writing NetBSD/FreeBSD/OpenBSD and Linux/ELF \i{Shared
7280 \c{ELF} replaced the older \c{a.out} object file format under Linux
7281 because it contains support for \i{position-independent code}
7282 (\i{PIC}), which makes writing shared libraries much easier. NASM
7283 supports the \c{ELF} position-independent code features, so you can
7284 write Linux \c{ELF} shared libraries in NASM.
7286 \i{NetBSD}, and its close cousins \i{FreeBSD} and \i{OpenBSD}, take
7287 a different approach by hacking PIC support into the \c{a.out}
7288 format. NASM supports this as the \i\c{aoutb} output format, so you
7289 can write \i{BSD} shared libraries in NASM too.
7291 The operating system loads a PIC shared library by memory-mapping
7292 the library file at an arbitrarily chosen point in the address space
7293 of the running process. The contents of the library's code section
7294 must therefore not depend on where it is loaded in memory.
7296 Therefore, you cannot get at your variables by writing code like
7299 \c mov eax,[myvar] ; WRONG
7301 Instead, the linker provides an area of memory called the
7302 \i\e{global offset table}, or \i{GOT}; the GOT is situated at a
7303 constant distance from your library's code, so if you can find out
7304 where your library is loaded (which is typically done using a
7305 \c{CALL} and \c{POP} combination), you can obtain the address of the
7306 GOT, and you can then load the addresses of your variables out of
7307 linker-generated entries in the GOT.
7309 The \e{data} section of a PIC shared library does not have these
7310 restrictions: since the data section is writable, it has to be
7311 copied into memory anyway rather than just paged in from the library
7312 file, so as long as it's being copied it can be relocated too. So
7313 you can put ordinary types of relocation in the data section without
7314 too much worry (but see \k{picglobal} for a caveat).
7317 \S{picgot} Obtaining the Address of the GOT
7319 Each code module in your shared library should define the GOT as an
7322 \c extern _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ ; in ELF
7323 \c extern __GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ ; in BSD a.out
7325 At the beginning of any function in your shared library which plans
7326 to access your data or BSS sections, you must first calculate the
7327 address of the GOT. This is typically done by writing the function
7336 \c add ebx,_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_+$$-.get_GOT wrt ..gotpc
7338 \c ; the function body comes here
7345 (For BSD, again, the symbol \c{_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE} requires a
7346 second leading underscore.)
7348 The first two lines of this function are simply the standard C
7349 prologue to set up a stack frame, and the last three lines are
7350 standard C function epilogue. The third line, and the fourth to last
7351 line, save and restore the \c{EBX} register, because PIC shared
7352 libraries use this register to store the address of the GOT.
7354 The interesting bit is the \c{CALL} instruction and the following
7355 two lines. The \c{CALL} and \c{POP} combination obtains the address
7356 of the label \c{.get_GOT}, without having to know in advance where
7357 the program was loaded (since the \c{CALL} instruction is encoded
7358 relative to the current position). The \c{ADD} instruction makes use
7359 of one of the special PIC relocation types: \i{GOTPC relocation}.
7360 With the \i\c{WRT ..gotpc} qualifier specified, the symbol
7361 referenced (here \c{_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_}, the special symbol
7362 assigned to the GOT) is given as an offset from the beginning of the
7363 section. (Actually, \c{ELF} encodes it as the offset from the operand
7364 field of the \c{ADD} instruction, but NASM simplifies this
7365 deliberately, so you do things the same way for both \c{ELF} and
7366 \c{BSD}.) So the instruction then \e{adds} the beginning of the section,
7367 to get the real address of the GOT, and subtracts the value of
7368 \c{.get_GOT} which it knows is in \c{EBX}. Therefore, by the time
7369 that instruction has finished, \c{EBX} contains the address of the GOT.
7371 If you didn't follow that, don't worry: it's never necessary to
7372 obtain the address of the GOT by any other means, so you can put
7373 those three instructions into a macro and safely ignore them:
7380 \c add ebx,_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_+$$-%%getgot wrt ..gotpc
7384 \S{piclocal} Finding Your Local Data Items
7386 Having got the GOT, you can then use it to obtain the addresses of
7387 your data items. Most variables will reside in the sections you have
7388 declared; they can be accessed using the \I{GOTOFF
7389 relocation}\c{..gotoff} special \I\c{WRT ..gotoff}\c{WRT} type. The
7390 way this works is like this:
7392 \c lea eax,[ebx+myvar wrt ..gotoff]
7394 The expression \c{myvar wrt ..gotoff} is calculated, when the shared
7395 library is linked, to be the offset to the local variable \c{myvar}
7396 from the beginning of the GOT. Therefore, adding it to \c{EBX} as
7397 above will place the real address of \c{myvar} in \c{EAX}.
7399 If you declare variables as \c{GLOBAL} without specifying a size for
7400 them, they are shared between code modules in the library, but do
7401 not get exported from the library to the program that loaded it.
7402 They will still be in your ordinary data and BSS sections, so you
7403 can access them in the same way as local variables, using the above
7404 \c{..gotoff} mechanism.
7406 Note that due to a peculiarity of the way BSD \c{a.out} format
7407 handles this relocation type, there must be at least one non-local
7408 symbol in the same section as the address you're trying to access.
7411 \S{picextern} Finding External and Common Data Items
7413 If your library needs to get at an external variable (external to
7414 the \e{library}, not just to one of the modules within it), you must
7415 use the \I{GOT relocations}\I\c{WRT ..got}\c{..got} type to get at
7416 it. The \c{..got} type, instead of giving you the offset from the
7417 GOT base to the variable, gives you the offset from the GOT base to
7418 a GOT \e{entry} containing the address of the variable. The linker
7419 will set up this GOT entry when it builds the library, and the
7420 dynamic linker will place the correct address in it at load time. So
7421 to obtain the address of an external variable \c{extvar} in \c{EAX},
7424 \c mov eax,[ebx+extvar wrt ..got]
7426 This loads the address of \c{extvar} out of an entry in the GOT. The
7427 linker, when it builds the shared library, collects together every
7428 relocation of type \c{..got}, and builds the GOT so as to ensure it
7429 has every necessary entry present.
7431 Common variables must also be accessed in this way.
7434 \S{picglobal} Exporting Symbols to the Library User
7436 If you want to export symbols to the user of the library, you have
7437 to declare whether they are functions or data, and if they are data,
7438 you have to give the size of the data item. This is because the
7439 dynamic linker has to build \I{PLT}\i{procedure linkage table}
7440 entries for any exported functions, and also moves exported data
7441 items away from the library's data section in which they were
7444 So to export a function to users of the library, you must use
7446 \c global func:function ; declare it as a function
7452 And to export a data item such as an array, you would have to code
7454 \c global array:data array.end-array ; give the size too
7459 Be careful: If you export a variable to the library user, by
7460 declaring it as \c{GLOBAL} and supplying a size, the variable will
7461 end up living in the data section of the main program, rather than
7462 in your library's data section, where you declared it. So you will
7463 have to access your own global variable with the \c{..got} mechanism
7464 rather than \c{..gotoff}, as if it were external (which,
7465 effectively, it has become).
7467 Equally, if you need to store the address of an exported global in
7468 one of your data sections, you can't do it by means of the standard
7471 \c dataptr: dd global_data_item ; WRONG
7473 NASM will interpret this code as an ordinary relocation, in which
7474 \c{global_data_item} is merely an offset from the beginning of the
7475 \c{.data} section (or whatever); so this reference will end up
7476 pointing at your data section instead of at the exported global
7477 which resides elsewhere.
7479 Instead of the above code, then, you must write
7481 \c dataptr: dd global_data_item wrt ..sym
7483 which makes use of the special \c{WRT} type \I\c{WRT ..sym}\c{..sym}
7484 to instruct NASM to search the symbol table for a particular symbol
7485 at that address, rather than just relocating by section base.
7487 Either method will work for functions: referring to one of your
7488 functions by means of
7490 \c funcptr: dd my_function
7492 will give the user the address of the code you wrote, whereas
7494 \c funcptr: dd my_function wrt ..sym
7496 will give the address of the procedure linkage table for the
7497 function, which is where the calling program will \e{believe} the
7498 function lives. Either address is a valid way to call the function.
7501 \S{picproc} Calling Procedures Outside the Library
7503 Calling procedures outside your shared library has to be done by
7504 means of a \i\e{procedure linkage table}, or \i{PLT}. The PLT is
7505 placed at a known offset from where the library is loaded, so the
7506 library code can make calls to the PLT in a position-independent
7507 way. Within the PLT there is code to jump to offsets contained in
7508 the GOT, so function calls to other shared libraries or to routines
7509 in the main program can be transparently passed off to their real
7512 To call an external routine, you must use another special PIC
7513 relocation type, \I{PLT relocations}\i\c{WRT ..plt}. This is much
7514 easier than the GOT-based ones: you simply replace calls such as
7515 \c{CALL printf} with the PLT-relative version \c{CALL printf WRT
7519 \S{link} Generating the Library File
7521 Having written some code modules and assembled them to \c{.o} files,
7522 you then generate your shared library with a command such as
7524 \c ld -shared -o library.so module1.o module2.o # for ELF
7525 \c ld -Bshareable -o library.so module1.o module2.o # for BSD
7527 For ELF, if your shared library is going to reside in system
7528 directories such as \c{/usr/lib} or \c{/lib}, it is usually worth
7529 using the \i\c{-soname} flag to the linker, to store the final
7530 library file name, with a version number, into the library:
7532 \c ld -shared -soname library.so.1 -o library.so.1.2 *.o
7534 You would then copy \c{library.so.1.2} into the library directory,
7535 and create \c{library.so.1} as a symbolic link to it.
7538 \C{mixsize} Mixing 16 and 32 Bit Code
7540 This chapter tries to cover some of the issues, largely related to
7541 unusual forms of addressing and jump instructions, encountered when
7542 writing operating system code such as protected-mode initialisation
7543 routines, which require code that operates in mixed segment sizes,
7544 such as code in a 16-bit segment trying to modify data in a 32-bit
7545 one, or jumps between different-size segments.
7548 \H{mixjump} Mixed-Size Jumps\I{jumps, mixed-size}
7550 \I{operating system, writing}\I{writing operating systems}The most
7551 common form of \i{mixed-size instruction} is the one used when
7552 writing a 32-bit OS: having done your setup in 16-bit mode, such as
7553 loading the kernel, you then have to boot it by switching into
7554 protected mode and jumping to the 32-bit kernel start address. In a
7555 fully 32-bit OS, this tends to be the \e{only} mixed-size
7556 instruction you need, since everything before it can be done in pure
7557 16-bit code, and everything after it can be pure 32-bit.
7559 This jump must specify a 48-bit far address, since the target
7560 segment is a 32-bit one. However, it must be assembled in a 16-bit
7561 segment, so just coding, for example,
7563 \c jmp 0x1234:0x56789ABC ; wrong!
7565 will not work, since the offset part of the address will be
7566 truncated to \c{0x9ABC} and the jump will be an ordinary 16-bit far
7569 The Linux kernel setup code gets round the inability of \c{as86} to
7570 generate the required instruction by coding it manually, using
7571 \c{DB} instructions. NASM can go one better than that, by actually
7572 generating the right instruction itself. Here's how to do it right:
7574 \c jmp dword 0x1234:0x56789ABC ; right
7576 \I\c{JMP DWORD}The \c{DWORD} prefix (strictly speaking, it should
7577 come \e{after} the colon, since it is declaring the \e{offset} field
7578 to be a doubleword; but NASM will accept either form, since both are
7579 unambiguous) forces the offset part to be treated as far, in the
7580 assumption that you are deliberately writing a jump from a 16-bit
7581 segment to a 32-bit one.
7583 You can do the reverse operation, jumping from a 32-bit segment to a
7584 16-bit one, by means of the \c{WORD} prefix:
7586 \c jmp word 0x8765:0x4321 ; 32 to 16 bit
7588 If the \c{WORD} prefix is specified in 16-bit mode, or the \c{DWORD}
7589 prefix in 32-bit mode, they will be ignored, since each is
7590 explicitly forcing NASM into a mode it was in anyway.
7593 \H{mixaddr} Addressing Between Different-Size Segments\I{addressing,
7594 mixed-size}\I{mixed-size addressing}
7596 If your OS is mixed 16 and 32-bit, or if you are writing a DOS
7597 extender, you are likely to have to deal with some 16-bit segments
7598 and some 32-bit ones. At some point, you will probably end up
7599 writing code in a 16-bit segment which has to access data in a
7600 32-bit segment, or vice versa.
7602 If the data you are trying to access in a 32-bit segment lies within
7603 the first 64K of the segment, you may be able to get away with using
7604 an ordinary 16-bit addressing operation for the purpose; but sooner
7605 or later, you will want to do 32-bit addressing from 16-bit mode.
7607 The easiest way to do this is to make sure you use a register for
7608 the address, since any effective address containing a 32-bit
7609 register is forced to be a 32-bit address. So you can do
7611 \c mov eax,offset_into_32_bit_segment_specified_by_fs
7612 \c mov dword [fs:eax],0x11223344
7614 This is fine, but slightly cumbersome (since it wastes an
7615 instruction and a register) if you already know the precise offset
7616 you are aiming at. The x86 architecture does allow 32-bit effective
7617 addresses to specify nothing but a 4-byte offset, so why shouldn't
7618 NASM be able to generate the best instruction for the purpose?
7620 It can. As in \k{mixjump}, you need only prefix the address with the
7621 \c{DWORD} keyword, and it will be forced to be a 32-bit address:
7623 \c mov dword [fs:dword my_offset],0x11223344
7625 Also as in \k{mixjump}, NASM is not fussy about whether the
7626 \c{DWORD} prefix comes before or after the segment override, so
7627 arguably a nicer-looking way to code the above instruction is
7629 \c mov dword [dword fs:my_offset],0x11223344
7631 Don't confuse the \c{DWORD} prefix \e{outside} the square brackets,
7632 which controls the size of the data stored at the address, with the
7633 one \c{inside} the square brackets which controls the length of the
7634 address itself. The two can quite easily be different:
7636 \c mov word [dword 0x12345678],0x9ABC
7638 This moves 16 bits of data to an address specified by a 32-bit
7641 You can also specify \c{WORD} or \c{DWORD} prefixes along with the
7642 \c{FAR} prefix to indirect far jumps or calls. For example:
7644 \c call dword far [fs:word 0x4321]
7646 This instruction contains an address specified by a 16-bit offset;
7647 it loads a 48-bit far pointer from that (16-bit segment and 32-bit
7648 offset), and calls that address.
7651 \H{mixother} Other Mixed-Size Instructions
7653 The other way you might want to access data might be using the
7654 string instructions (\c{LODSx}, \c{STOSx} and so on) or the
7655 \c{XLATB} instruction. These instructions, since they take no
7656 parameters, might seem to have no easy way to make them perform
7657 32-bit addressing when assembled in a 16-bit segment.
7659 This is the purpose of NASM's \i\c{a16}, \i\c{a32} and \i\c{a64} prefixes. If
7660 you are coding \c{LODSB} in a 16-bit segment but it is supposed to
7661 be accessing a string in a 32-bit segment, you should load the
7662 desired address into \c{ESI} and then code
7666 The prefix forces the addressing size to 32 bits, meaning that
7667 \c{LODSB} loads from \c{[DS:ESI]} instead of \c{[DS:SI]}. To access
7668 a string in a 16-bit segment when coding in a 32-bit one, the
7669 corresponding \c{a16} prefix can be used.
7671 The \c{a16}, \c{a32} and \c{a64} prefixes can be applied to any instruction
7672 in NASM's instruction table, but most of them can generate all the
7673 useful forms without them. The prefixes are necessary only for
7674 instructions with implicit addressing:
7675 \# \c{CMPSx} (\k{insCMPSB}),
7676 \# \c{SCASx} (\k{insSCASB}), \c{LODSx} (\k{insLODSB}), \c{STOSx}
7677 \# (\k{insSTOSB}), \c{MOVSx} (\k{insMOVSB}), \c{INSx} (\k{insINSB}),
7678 \# \c{OUTSx} (\k{insOUTSB}), and \c{XLATB} (\k{insXLATB}).
7679 \c{CMPSx}, \c{SCASx}, \c{LODSx}, \c{STOSx}, \c{MOVSx}, \c{INSx},
7680 \c{OUTSx}, and \c{XLATB}.
7682 various push and pop instructions (\c{PUSHA} and \c{POPF} as well as
7683 the more usual \c{PUSH} and \c{POP}) can accept \c{a16}, \c{a32} or \c{a64}
7684 prefixes to force a particular one of \c{SP}, \c{ESP} or \c{RSP} to be used
7685 as a stack pointer, in case the stack segment in use is a different
7686 size from the code segment.
7688 \c{PUSH} and \c{POP}, when applied to segment registers in 32-bit
7689 mode, also have the slightly odd behaviour that they push and pop 4
7690 bytes at a time, of which the top two are ignored and the bottom two
7691 give the value of the segment register being manipulated. To force
7692 the 16-bit behaviour of segment-register push and pop instructions,
7693 you can use the operand-size prefix \i\c{o16}:
7698 This code saves a doubleword of stack space by fitting two segment
7699 registers into the space which would normally be consumed by pushing
7702 (You can also use the \i\c{o32} prefix to force the 32-bit behaviour
7703 when in 16-bit mode, but this seems less useful.)
7706 \C{64bit} Writing 64-bit Code (Unix, Win64)
7708 This chapter attempts to cover some of the common issues involved when
7709 writing 64-bit code, to run under \i{Win64} or Unix. It covers how to
7710 write assembly code to interface with 64-bit C routines, and how to
7711 write position-independent code for shared libraries.
7713 All 64-bit code uses a flat memory model, since segmentation is not
7714 available in 64-bit mode. The one exception is the \c{FS} and \c{GS}
7715 registers, which still add their bases.
7717 Position independence in 64-bit mode is significantly simpler, since
7718 the processor supports \c{RIP}-relative addressing directly; see the
7719 \c{REL} keyword (\k{effaddr}). On most 64-bit platforms, it is
7720 probably desirable to make that the default, using the directive
7721 \c{DEFAULT REL} (\k{default}).
7723 64-bit programming is relatively similar to 32-bit programming, but
7724 of course pointers are 64 bits long; additionally, all existing
7725 platforms pass arguments in registers rather than on the stack.
7726 Furthermore, 64-bit platforms use SSE2 by default for floating point.
7727 Please see the ABI documentation for your platform.
7729 64-bit platforms differ in the sizes of the fundamental datatypes, not
7730 just from 32-bit platforms but from each other. If a specific size
7731 data type is desired, it is probably best to use the types defined in
7732 the Standard C header \c{<inttypes.h>}.
7734 In 64-bit mode, the default instruction size is still 32 bits. When
7735 loading a value into a 32-bit register (but not an 8- or 16-bit
7736 register), the upper 32 bits of the corresponding 64-bit register are
7739 \H{reg64} Register Names in 64-bit Mode
7741 NASM uses the following names for general-purpose registers in 64-bit
7742 mode, for 8-, 16-, 32- and 64-bit references, respectively:
7744 \c AL/AH, CL/CH, DL/DH, BL/BH, SPL, BPL, SIL, DIL, R8B-R15B
7745 \c AX, CX, DX, BX, SP, BP, SI, DI, R8W-R15W
7746 \c EAX, ECX, EDX, EBX, ESP, EBP, ESI, EDI, R8D-R15D
7747 \c RAX, RCX, RDX, RBX, RSP, RBP, RSI, RDI, R8-R15
7749 This is consistent with the AMD documentation and most other
7750 assemblers. The Intel documentation, however, uses the names
7751 \c{R8L-R15L} for 8-bit references to the higher registers. It is
7752 possible to use those names by definiting them as macros; similarly,
7753 if one wants to use numeric names for the low 8 registers, define them
7754 as macros. The standard macro package \c{altreg} (see \k{pkg_altreg})
7755 can be used for this purpose.
7757 \H{id64} Immediates and Displacements in 64-bit Mode
7759 In 64-bit mode, immediates and displacements are generally only 32
7760 bits wide. NASM will therefore truncate most displacements and
7761 immediates to 32 bits.
7763 The only instruction which takes a full \i{64-bit immediate} is:
7767 NASM will produce this instruction whenever the programmer uses
7768 \c{MOV} with an immediate into a 64-bit register. If this is not
7769 desirable, simply specify the equivalent 32-bit register, which will
7770 be automatically zero-extended by the processor, or specify the
7771 immediate as \c{DWORD}:
7773 \c mov rax,foo ; 64-bit immediate
7774 \c mov rax,qword foo ; (identical)
7775 \c mov eax,foo ; 32-bit immediate, zero-extended
7776 \c mov rax,dword foo ; 32-bit immediate, sign-extended
7778 The length of these instructions are 10, 5 and 7 bytes, respectively.
7780 The only instructions which take a full \I{64-bit displacement}64-bit
7781 \e{displacement} is loading or storing, using \c{MOV}, \c{AL}, \c{AX},
7782 \c{EAX} or \c{RAX} (but no other registers) to an absolute 64-bit address.
7783 Since this is a relatively rarely used instruction (64-bit code generally uses
7784 relative addressing), the programmer has to explicitly declare the
7785 displacement size as \c{QWORD}:
7789 \c mov eax,[foo] ; 32-bit absolute disp, sign-extended
7790 \c mov eax,[a32 foo] ; 32-bit absolute disp, zero-extended
7791 \c mov eax,[qword foo] ; 64-bit absolute disp
7795 \c mov eax,[foo] ; 32-bit relative disp
7796 \c mov eax,[a32 foo] ; d:o, address truncated to 32 bits(!)
7797 \c mov eax,[qword foo] ; error
7798 \c mov eax,[abs qword foo] ; 64-bit absolute disp
7800 A sign-extended absolute displacement can access from -2 GB to +2 GB;
7801 a zero-extended absolute displacement can access from 0 to 4 GB.
7803 \H{unix64} Interfacing to 64-bit C Programs (Unix)
7805 On Unix, the 64-bit ABI is defined by the document:
7807 \W{http://www.nasm.us/links/unix64abi}\c{http://www.nasm.us/links/unix64abi}
7809 Although written for AT&T-syntax assembly, the concepts apply equally
7810 well for NASM-style assembly. What follows is a simplified summary.
7812 The first six integer arguments (from the left) are passed in \c{RDI},
7813 \c{RSI}, \c{RDX}, \c{RCX}, \c{R8}, and \c{R9}, in that order.
7814 Additional integer arguments are passed on the stack. These
7815 registers, plus \c{RAX}, \c{R10} and \c{R11} are destroyed by function
7816 calls, and thus are available for use by the function without saving.
7818 Integer return values are passed in \c{RAX} and \c{RDX}, in that order.
7820 Floating point is done using SSE registers, except for \c{long
7821 double}. Floating-point arguments are passed in \c{XMM0} to \c{XMM7};
7822 return is \c{XMM0} and \c{XMM1}. \c{long double} are passed on the
7823 stack, and returned in \c{ST0} and \c{ST1}.
7825 All SSE and x87 registers are destroyed by function calls.
7827 On 64-bit Unix, \c{long} is 64 bits.
7829 Integer and SSE register arguments are counted separately, so for the case of
7831 \c void foo(long a, double b, int c)
7833 \c{a} is passed in \c{RDI}, \c{b} in \c{XMM0}, and \c{c} in \c{ESI}.
7835 \H{win64} Interfacing to 64-bit C Programs (Win64)
7837 The Win64 ABI is described at:
7839 \W{http://www.nasm.us/links/win64abi}\c{http://www.nasm.us/links/win64abi}
7841 What follows is a simplified summary.
7843 The first four integer arguments are passed in \c{RCX}, \c{RDX},
7844 \c{R8} and \c{R9}, in that order. Additional integer arguments are
7845 passed on the stack. These registers, plus \c{RAX}, \c{R10} and
7846 \c{R11} are destroyed by function calls, and thus are available for
7847 use by the function without saving.
7849 Integer return values are passed in \c{RAX} only.
7851 Floating point is done using SSE registers, except for \c{long
7852 double}. Floating-point arguments are passed in \c{XMM0} to \c{XMM3};
7853 return is \c{XMM0} only.
7855 On Win64, \c{long} is 32 bits; \c{long long} or \c{_int64} is 64 bits.
7857 Integer and SSE register arguments are counted together, so for the case of
7859 \c void foo(long long a, double b, int c)
7861 \c{a} is passed in \c{RCX}, \c{b} in \c{XMM1}, and \c{c} in \c{R8D}.
7863 \C{trouble} Troubleshooting
7865 This chapter describes some of the common problems that users have
7866 been known to encounter with NASM, and answers them. It also gives
7867 instructions for reporting bugs in NASM if you find a difficulty
7868 that isn't listed here.
7871 \H{problems} Common Problems
7873 \S{inefficient} NASM Generates \i{Inefficient Code}
7875 We sometimes get `bug' reports about NASM generating inefficient, or
7876 even `wrong', code on instructions such as \c{ADD ESP,8}. This is a
7877 deliberate design feature, connected to predictability of output:
7878 NASM, on seeing \c{ADD ESP,8}, will generate the form of the
7879 instruction which leaves room for a 32-bit offset. You need to code
7880 \I\c{BYTE}\c{ADD ESP,BYTE 8} if you want the space-efficient form of
7881 the instruction. This isn't a bug, it's user error: if you prefer to
7882 have NASM produce the more efficient code automatically enable
7883 optimization with the \c{-O} option (see \k{opt-O}).
7886 \S{jmprange} My Jumps are Out of Range\I{out of range, jumps}
7888 Similarly, people complain that when they issue \i{conditional
7889 jumps} (which are \c{SHORT} by default) that try to jump too far,
7890 NASM reports `short jump out of range' instead of making the jumps
7893 This, again, is partly a predictability issue, but in fact has a
7894 more practical reason as well. NASM has no means of being told what
7895 type of processor the code it is generating will be run on; so it
7896 cannot decide for itself that it should generate \i\c{Jcc NEAR} type
7897 instructions, because it doesn't know that it's working for a 386 or
7898 above. Alternatively, it could replace the out-of-range short
7899 \c{JNE} instruction with a very short \c{JE} instruction that jumps
7900 over a \c{JMP NEAR}; this is a sensible solution for processors
7901 below a 386, but hardly efficient on processors which have good
7902 branch prediction \e{and} could have used \c{JNE NEAR} instead. So,
7903 once again, it's up to the user, not the assembler, to decide what
7904 instructions should be generated. See \k{opt-O}.
7907 \S{proborg} \i\c{ORG} Doesn't Work
7909 People writing \i{boot sector} programs in the \c{bin} format often
7910 complain that \c{ORG} doesn't work the way they'd like: in order to
7911 place the \c{0xAA55} signature word at the end of a 512-byte boot
7912 sector, people who are used to MASM tend to code
7916 \c ; some boot sector code
7921 This is not the intended use of the \c{ORG} directive in NASM, and
7922 will not work. The correct way to solve this problem in NASM is to
7923 use the \i\c{TIMES} directive, like this:
7927 \c ; some boot sector code
7929 \c TIMES 510-($-$$) DB 0
7932 The \c{TIMES} directive will insert exactly enough zero bytes into
7933 the output to move the assembly point up to 510. This method also
7934 has the advantage that if you accidentally fill your boot sector too
7935 full, NASM will catch the problem at assembly time and report it, so
7936 you won't end up with a boot sector that you have to disassemble to
7937 find out what's wrong with it.
7940 \S{probtimes} \i\c{TIMES} Doesn't Work
7942 The other common problem with the above code is people who write the
7947 by reasoning that \c{$} should be a pure number, just like 510, so
7948 the difference between them is also a pure number and can happily be
7951 NASM is a \e{modular} assembler: the various component parts are
7952 designed to be easily separable for re-use, so they don't exchange
7953 information unnecessarily. In consequence, the \c{bin} output
7954 format, even though it has been told by the \c{ORG} directive that
7955 the \c{.text} section should start at 0, does not pass that
7956 information back to the expression evaluator. So from the
7957 evaluator's point of view, \c{$} isn't a pure number: it's an offset
7958 from a section base. Therefore the difference between \c{$} and 510
7959 is also not a pure number, but involves a section base. Values
7960 involving section bases cannot be passed as arguments to \c{TIMES}.
7962 The solution, as in the previous section, is to code the \c{TIMES}
7965 \c TIMES 510-($-$$) DB 0
7967 in which \c{$} and \c{$$} are offsets from the same section base,
7968 and so their difference is a pure number. This will solve the
7969 problem and generate sensible code.
7972 \H{bugs} \i{Bugs}\I{reporting bugs}
7974 We have never yet released a version of NASM with any \e{known}
7975 bugs. That doesn't usually stop there being plenty we didn't know
7976 about, though. Any that you find should be reported firstly via the
7978 \W{http://www.nasm.us/}\c{http://www.nasm.us/}
7979 (click on "Bug Tracker"), or if that fails then through one of the
7980 contacts in \k{contact}.
7982 Please read \k{qstart} first, and don't report the bug if it's
7983 listed in there as a deliberate feature. (If you think the feature
7984 is badly thought out, feel free to send us reasons why you think it
7985 should be changed, but don't just send us mail saying `This is a
7986 bug' if the documentation says we did it on purpose.) Then read
7987 \k{problems}, and don't bother reporting the bug if it's listed
7990 If you do report a bug, \e{please} give us all of the following
7993 \b What operating system you're running NASM under. DOS, Linux,
7994 NetBSD, Win16, Win32, VMS (I'd be impressed), whatever.
7996 \b If you're running NASM under DOS or Win32, tell us whether you've
7997 compiled your own executable from the DOS source archive, or whether
7998 you were using the standard distribution binaries out of the
7999 archive. If you were using a locally built executable, try to
8000 reproduce the problem using one of the standard binaries, as this
8001 will make it easier for us to reproduce your problem prior to fixing
8004 \b Which version of NASM you're using, and exactly how you invoked
8005 it. Give us the precise command line, and the contents of the
8006 \c{NASMENV} environment variable if any.
8008 \b Which versions of any supplementary programs you're using, and
8009 how you invoked them. If the problem only becomes visible at link
8010 time, tell us what linker you're using, what version of it you've
8011 got, and the exact linker command line. If the problem involves
8012 linking against object files generated by a compiler, tell us what
8013 compiler, what version, and what command line or options you used.
8014 (If you're compiling in an IDE, please try to reproduce the problem
8015 with the command-line version of the compiler.)
8017 \b If at all possible, send us a NASM source file which exhibits the
8018 problem. If this causes copyright problems (e.g. you can only
8019 reproduce the bug in restricted-distribution code) then bear in mind
8020 the following two points: firstly, we guarantee that any source code
8021 sent to us for the purposes of debugging NASM will be used \e{only}
8022 for the purposes of debugging NASM, and that we will delete all our
8023 copies of it as soon as we have found and fixed the bug or bugs in
8024 question; and secondly, we would prefer \e{not} to be mailed large
8025 chunks of code anyway. The smaller the file, the better. A
8026 three-line sample file that does nothing useful \e{except}
8027 demonstrate the problem is much easier to work with than a
8028 fully fledged ten-thousand-line program. (Of course, some errors
8029 \e{do} only crop up in large files, so this may not be possible.)
8031 \b A description of what the problem actually \e{is}. `It doesn't
8032 work' is \e{not} a helpful description! Please describe exactly what
8033 is happening that shouldn't be, or what isn't happening that should.
8034 Examples might be: `NASM generates an error message saying Line 3
8035 for an error that's actually on Line 5'; `NASM generates an error
8036 message that I believe it shouldn't be generating at all'; `NASM
8037 fails to generate an error message that I believe it \e{should} be
8038 generating'; `the object file produced from this source code crashes
8039 my linker'; `the ninth byte of the output file is 66 and I think it
8040 should be 77 instead'.
8042 \b If you believe the output file from NASM to be faulty, send it to
8043 us. That allows us to determine whether our own copy of NASM
8044 generates the same file, or whether the problem is related to
8045 portability issues between our development platforms and yours. We
8046 can handle binary files mailed to us as MIME attachments, uuencoded,
8047 and even BinHex. Alternatively, we may be able to provide an FTP
8048 site you can upload the suspect files to; but mailing them is easier
8051 \b Any other information or data files that might be helpful. If,
8052 for example, the problem involves NASM failing to generate an object
8053 file while TASM can generate an equivalent file without trouble,
8054 then send us \e{both} object files, so we can see what TASM is doing
8055 differently from us.
8058 \A{ndisasm} \i{Ndisasm}
8060 The Netwide Disassembler, NDISASM
8062 \H{ndisintro} Introduction
8065 The Netwide Disassembler is a small companion program to the Netwide
8066 Assembler, NASM. It seemed a shame to have an x86 assembler,
8067 complete with a full instruction table, and not make as much use of
8068 it as possible, so here's a disassembler which shares the
8069 instruction table (and some other bits of code) with NASM.
8071 The Netwide Disassembler does nothing except to produce
8072 disassemblies of \e{binary} source files. NDISASM does not have any
8073 understanding of object file formats, like \c{objdump}, and it will
8074 not understand \c{DOS .EXE} files like \c{debug} will. It just
8078 \H{ndisstart} Getting Started: Installation
8080 See \k{install} for installation instructions. NDISASM, like NASM,
8081 has a \c{man page} which you may want to put somewhere useful, if you
8082 are on a Unix system.
8085 \H{ndisrun} Running NDISASM
8087 To disassemble a file, you will typically use a command of the form
8089 \c ndisasm -b {16|32|64} filename
8091 NDISASM can disassemble 16-, 32- or 64-bit code equally easily,
8092 provided of course that you remember to specify which it is to work
8093 with. If no \i\c{-b} switch is present, NDISASM works in 16-bit mode
8094 by default. The \i\c{-u} switch (for USE32) also invokes 32-bit mode.
8096 Two more command line options are \i\c{-r} which reports the version
8097 number of NDISASM you are running, and \i\c{-h} which gives a short
8098 summary of command line options.
8101 \S{ndiscom} COM Files: Specifying an Origin
8103 To disassemble a \c{DOS .COM} file correctly, a disassembler must assume
8104 that the first instruction in the file is loaded at address \c{0x100},
8105 rather than at zero. NDISASM, which assumes by default that any file
8106 you give it is loaded at zero, will therefore need to be informed of
8109 The \i\c{-o} option allows you to declare a different origin for the
8110 file you are disassembling. Its argument may be expressed in any of
8111 the NASM numeric formats: decimal by default, if it begins with `\c{$}'
8112 or `\c{0x}' or ends in `\c{H}' it's \c{hex}, if it ends in `\c{Q}' it's
8113 \c{octal}, and if it ends in `\c{B}' it's \c{binary}.
8115 Hence, to disassemble a \c{.COM} file:
8117 \c ndisasm -o100h filename.com
8122 \S{ndissync} Code Following Data: Synchronisation
8124 Suppose you are disassembling a file which contains some data which
8125 isn't machine code, and \e{then} contains some machine code. NDISASM
8126 will faithfully plough through the data section, producing machine
8127 instructions wherever it can (although most of them will look
8128 bizarre, and some may have unusual prefixes, e.g. `\c{FS OR AX,0x240A}'),
8129 and generating `DB' instructions ever so often if it's totally stumped.
8130 Then it will reach the code section.
8132 Supposing NDISASM has just finished generating a strange machine
8133 instruction from part of the data section, and its file position is
8134 now one byte \e{before} the beginning of the code section. It's
8135 entirely possible that another spurious instruction will get
8136 generated, starting with the final byte of the data section, and
8137 then the correct first instruction in the code section will not be
8138 seen because the starting point skipped over it. This isn't really
8141 To avoid this, you can specify a `\i\c{synchronisation}' point, or indeed
8142 as many synchronisation points as you like (although NDISASM can
8143 only handle 2147483647 sync points internally). The definition of a sync
8144 point is this: NDISASM guarantees to hit sync points exactly during
8145 disassembly. If it is thinking about generating an instruction which
8146 would cause it to jump over a sync point, it will discard that
8147 instruction and output a `\c{db}' instead. So it \e{will} start
8148 disassembly exactly from the sync point, and so you \e{will} see all
8149 the instructions in your code section.
8151 Sync points are specified using the \i\c{-s} option: they are measured
8152 in terms of the program origin, not the file position. So if you
8153 want to synchronize after 32 bytes of a \c{.COM} file, you would have to
8156 \c ndisasm -o100h -s120h file.com
8160 \c ndisasm -o100h -s20h file.com
8162 As stated above, you can specify multiple sync markers if you need
8163 to, just by repeating the \c{-s} option.
8166 \S{ndisisync} Mixed Code and Data: Automatic (Intelligent) Synchronisation
8169 Suppose you are disassembling the boot sector of a \c{DOS} floppy (maybe
8170 it has a virus, and you need to understand the virus so that you
8171 know what kinds of damage it might have done you). Typically, this
8172 will contain a \c{JMP} instruction, then some data, then the rest of the
8173 code. So there is a very good chance of NDISASM being \e{misaligned}
8174 when the data ends and the code begins. Hence a sync point is
8177 On the other hand, why should you have to specify the sync point
8178 manually? What you'd do in order to find where the sync point would
8179 be, surely, would be to read the \c{JMP} instruction, and then to use
8180 its target address as a sync point. So can NDISASM do that for you?
8182 The answer, of course, is yes: using either of the synonymous
8183 switches \i\c{-a} (for automatic sync) or \i\c{-i} (for intelligent
8184 sync) will enable \c{auto-sync} mode. Auto-sync mode automatically
8185 generates a sync point for any forward-referring PC-relative jump or
8186 call instruction that NDISASM encounters. (Since NDISASM is one-pass,
8187 if it encounters a PC-relative jump whose target has already been
8188 processed, there isn't much it can do about it...)
8190 Only PC-relative jumps are processed, since an absolute jump is
8191 either through a register (in which case NDISASM doesn't know what
8192 the register contains) or involves a segment address (in which case
8193 the target code isn't in the same segment that NDISASM is working
8194 in, and so the sync point can't be placed anywhere useful).
8196 For some kinds of file, this mechanism will automatically put sync
8197 points in all the right places, and save you from having to place
8198 any sync points manually. However, it should be stressed that
8199 auto-sync mode is \e{not} guaranteed to catch all the sync points, and
8200 you may still have to place some manually.
8202 Auto-sync mode doesn't prevent you from declaring manual sync
8203 points: it just adds automatically generated ones to the ones you
8204 provide. It's perfectly feasible to specify \c{-i} \e{and} some \c{-s}
8207 Another caveat with auto-sync mode is that if, by some unpleasant
8208 fluke, something in your data section should disassemble to a
8209 PC-relative call or jump instruction, NDISASM may obediently place a
8210 sync point in a totally random place, for example in the middle of
8211 one of the instructions in your code section. So you may end up with
8212 a wrong disassembly even if you use auto-sync. Again, there isn't
8213 much I can do about this. If you have problems, you'll have to use
8214 manual sync points, or use the \c{-k} option (documented below) to
8215 suppress disassembly of the data area.
8218 \S{ndisother} Other Options
8220 The \i\c{-e} option skips a header on the file, by ignoring the first N
8221 bytes. This means that the header is \e{not} counted towards the
8222 disassembly offset: if you give \c{-e10 -o10}, disassembly will start
8223 at byte 10 in the file, and this will be given offset 10, not 20.
8225 The \i\c{-k} option is provided with two comma-separated numeric
8226 arguments, the first of which is an assembly offset and the second
8227 is a number of bytes to skip. This \e{will} count the skipped bytes
8228 towards the assembly offset: its use is to suppress disassembly of a
8229 data section which wouldn't contain anything you wanted to see
8233 \H{ndisbugs} Bugs and Improvements
8235 There are no known bugs. However, any you find, with patches if
8236 possible, should be sent to
8237 \W{mailto:nasm-bugs@lists.sourceforge.net}\c{nasm-bugs@lists.sourceforge.net}, or to the
8239 \W{http://www.nasm.us/}\c{http://www.nasm.us/}
8240 and we'll try to fix them. Feel free to send contributions and
8241 new features as well.
8243 \A{inslist} \i{Instruction List}
8245 \H{inslistintro} Introduction
8247 The following sections show the instructions which NASM currently supports. For each
8248 instruction, there is a separate entry for each supported addressing mode. The third
8249 column shows the processor type in which the instruction was introduced and,
8250 when appropriate, one or more usage flags.
8254 \A{changelog} \i{NASM Version History}